B Tech TT
B Tech TT
PROGRAM OUTCOMES:
1
5. Create, select, and apply appropriate techniques, resources, and modern engineering and
IT tools for managing textile manufacturing companies with an understanding of the
limitations
6. Apply reasoning gained through the contextual knowledge to assess societal, health,
safety, legal and cultural issues and the consequent responsibilities relevant to the
profession
7. Understand the impact of the developed solutions in societal and environmental contexts,
and demonstrate the knowledge for sustainable development
8. Understand ethical and professional responsibilities
9. Function effectively as an individual, and as a member or leader in diverse teams in the
profession
10. Communicate effectively on complex engineering activities with the engineering
community and with society at large. Able to comprehend and write effective reports and
design documentation, make effective presentations, and give and receive clear
instructions.
11. Demonstrate knowledge and understanding of the engineering and management principles
and apply these to one’s own work, as a member and leader in a team, to manage
projectsand in multidisciplinary environments
12. Recognize the need for, and have the preparation and ability to engage in independent and
life-long learning in the broadest context of technological change.
1. Understand and apply fundamental and the technical knowledge for managing textile
manufacturing industry
2. Be a successful entrepreneur and designer in textile clothing.
3. Design and develop novel products and manufacturing processes in textile fields
2
PEO’s – PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PO PSO
PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PS PS PS
PEO
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 O1 O2 O3
I 3 3 3 1 2 2 2 3 2 3 2 1 3 3 2
II 3 3 3 3 1 1 2 1 1 2 2 1 2 2 1
III 3 3 3 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 1 1 3 3 2
IV 1 2 1 1 1 2 2 3 1 1 1 3 2 2 2
3
Year Seme
PO PSO
ster Course Name
HUMANITIES AND 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
SOCIALSCIENCES
INCLUDING
MANAGEMENT
COURSES
I I Professional English - I 1.6 2.2 1.8 2.2 1. 3 3 3 1.6 3 3 3 - - -
5
I II Professional English - II 3 3 3 3 2.75 3 3 3 2.2 3 3 3 - - -
/Heritage of Tamils
/
Tamils and Technology
Basic Science Courses [BSC] 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
I I Matrices and Calculus 3 3 1 1 0 0 0 0 2 0 2 3 - - -
I I Engineering Physics 3 3 1.6 1.2 1.8 1 - - - - - 1 - - -
I I Engineering Chemistry 2.8 1.3 1.6 1 - 1.5 1.8 - - - 1.5 - - -
I I Physics and Chemistry Laboratory 3 2.4 2.6 1 1
2.6 1.3 1.6 1 1 1.4 1.8 - - - - 1.3 - - -
I II Statistics and Numerical Methods 3 3 1 1 1 0 0 0 2 0 2 3 - - -
II III Probability and Statistical
3 3 3 2 1.2 0.8 0 0.2 0 0 1.2 1.2 1.6 1.2 1.6
Methods
II IV Environmental Science and 2.8 1.8 1 1 - 2.2 2.4 - - - - 1.8 - - -
Sustainability
ENGINEERING SCIENCE COURSE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
[ESC]
I I Problem Solving and Python
2 3 3 3 2 - - - - - 2 2 3 3
Programming
I I Problem Solving and Python
2 3 3 3 2 - - - - - 2 2 3 3
Programming Laboratory
I II Basic Electrical, Electronics and
2 1 1 1 - - -
Instrumentation Engineering
I II Engineering Graphics 3 1 2 2 3 2 2 2
I II Engineering Practices Laboratory 3 2 1 1 1 2 2 1 1
I II Basic Electrical, Electronics and
Instrumentation Engineering 1.6 1.4 0.8 1.6 1.2 1.6
Laboratory
4
II III Engineering Mechanics for Textile 3 3 3 2 2 1 1 - 1 1 1 2 2 2 1
Technologists
PROFESSIONAL CORE COURSES 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
[PCC]
II III Technology of Pre-Spinning
2.8 2.8 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 1
Process
II III Preparatory process for woven
3 3 3 2.28 2 - - - 2 2 2 1 3 1 2.71
Fabric Manufacture
II III Structure and Properties of Textile
3 3 2.28 3 2 - 1 - 1 2 1 1 3 1 2
Fibres
II III Production of Textile Fibres 3 3 2 2 1 2 2 - - - - 1 3 1 3
II III Pre Spinning Laboratory 3 3 3 3 2 - 1 - 2 2 2 1 3 1 2
II IV Technology of Yarn Spinning 3 3 3 2.28 2 - 1 - 2 2 2 1 3 1 1.28
II IV Technology of woven Fabric
3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
Manufacture
II IV
Knitting Technology 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
II IV Chemical Processing of Textile
3 2 2 2 2 - 2 - - - - 1 3 1 2
Materials I
II IV Woven Fabric Structure and 1 1 1.8 - 2. 1 1 1 2 1 1 1 2 2 2
Design 8
II IV Fabric Manufacture Laboratory 3 3 3 3 2 - 1 - 2 2 2 1 3 2 3
II IV Fabric Structure Analysis
3 3 3 1 - - - - 2 2 2 2 3 3 3
Laboratory
III V Testing of Textile Materials 3 3 2 3 2 - - 2 - - - 1 3 1 2
III V Testing of Textile Materials
3 2.17 3 1 1 - 1 - 2 1.16 2 2 3 3 3
Laboratory
III VI Chemical Processing of Textile
3 2 2 2 2 - 3 - - - - 1 3 1 2
Material II
III VI Technology of Nonwoven 3 2 2 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
III VI Textile Chemical Processing
3 3 3 3 - 1 1 - 2 1 1 1 3 1 2.33
Laboratory
III VI Textile Product Engineering
3 3 3 3 2 1 1 - 2 2 2 2 3 2 3
Laboratory
III VI Mechanics of Textile Machinery 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
III VI Apparel and Home Furnishings 2.2 2.28 2.28
3 1.57 2.28 2 1 - - - 2 2 2 1.28
Manufacture 8
III VI Financial Management for Textile
3 3 1 2 2 - - - - 2 2 1 3 2 1
Industries
5
PROFESSIONAL ELECTIVES
[PEC]
Process and Quality Control in
3 3 3 3 2 1 1 1 - - - 2 3 2 2
Spinning
Process and Quality Control in
3 3 3 3 2 1 1 1 - - - 2 3 2 2
Fabric Manufacture
Theory of Drafting and Twisting 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
Structure Mechanics of Yarns
and Fabrics
Production and application of
3 3 1 1 1 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
sewing threads
Textile Chemical and Auxiliaries 2.2 1.8 1.2 - - 2 1.4 - - - - - 2 - -
Garment Production Machinery 2.57 2.28 1.14 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 2 1 2 3 3
Industrial Engineering in 1.2 2 3 3 2 1 1.2 2 2 1 2.4 2 1 1 -
Garment Industry
Pattern Engineering 2 2 2 - 2 - - 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 1
Apparel Marketing and - 1 2.6 2 2 1 1 2. 2 1.2 1 - 2 2 2
Merchandising 4
Apparel Product Development 1.33 - - - - - 1 1.3 1. 1.3 1 3 2 1
Laboratory 3 33 3
Basic Sewing and Pattern - - - - 1 - - - - 1 1 - 1 2 1
Making Laboratory
Apparel Costing 3 2 - - 1 - - - - - 2 1 3 2 1
Operations Research in
3 2 2 3 3 - - - - 1 2 1 3 3 2
Textile Industry
Supply Chain Management 1 1 2 2 2 - - - 2 2 2 1 2 2 1
Textile and Apparel EXIM
2 1 1 2 1 - - - - 1 - 1 2 1 -
Management
Technical Textiles 3 2 3 3 2 - - - - - - 1 3 2 3
Medical Textiles 3 2 3 3 2 1 - - - - - 2 3 2 3
High Performance Fibres 3 2 2 2 1 - - - - - - 1 3 2 3
Smart Textiles 3 2 2 2 - - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
Protective Textiles 3 2 2 2 - - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
Coated Textiles 3 2 2 2 - - - - - - - 1 3 1 3
Home Textile 3 1 2 2 - - - - - - - 1 2 2 2
Characterization of Textile 3 - - 2 1 - - - - - - 1 3 1 1
Polymers
6
Clothing Comfort 3 2 2 2 1 - - - - - - 2 3 2 3
Textile Reinforced Composites 3 2 3 1 1 - 1 - - - - 2 3 2 2
Advances in Textile Printing 3 3 2 2 2 1 1 - - - - 1 3 1 2
and Finishes
Advanced Testing of Textiles 3 2 2 3 2 - 1 - - - - 1 3 1 2
EMPLOYABILITY 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
ENHANCEMENT COURSES
(EEC)
II IV Internship /Training I 3 3 2 2.6 2.8 2 2 2.1 2.1 3 2.4 2.6 2.6 2.8 2.4
III V Professional Development
III V Summer internship 3 3 2 2.6 2.8 2 2 2.1 2.1 3 2.4 2.6 2.6 2.8 2.4
IV VII Summer internship 3 3 2 2.6 2.8 2 2 2.1 2.1 3 2.4 2.6 2.6 2.8 2.4
IV VIII Project Work / Internship 3 3 3 3 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 1 3 2 3
1-Low,2-Medium,3-High,”-“-no correlation
7
ANNA UNIVERSITY, CHENNAI
NON-AUTONOMOUS COLLEGES AFFILIATED COLLEGES
REGULATIONS 2021
B. TECH. TEXTILE TECHNOLOGY
CHOICE BASED CREDIT SYSTEM (CBCS)
CURRICULUM AND SYLLABI FOR I AND VIII SEMESTERS
SEMESTER I
S. COURSE CATE- PERIODS PER TOTAL CREDITS
COURSE TITLE WEEK CONTACT
No. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
1. IP3151 Induction Programme - - - - - 0
THEORY
2. HS3152 Professional English - I HSMC 3 0 0 3 3
3. MA3151 Matrices and Calculus BSC 3 1 0 4 4
4. PH3151 Engineering Physics BSC 3 0 0 3 3
5. CY3151 Engineering Chemistry BSC 3 0 0 3 3
Problem Solving and Python
6. GE3151 ESC 3 0 0 3 3
Programming
7. GE3152 /Heritage of Tamils HSMC 1 0 0 1 1
PRACTICALS
8. GE3171 Problem Solving and Python ESC 0 0 4 4 2
Programming Laboratory
Physics and Chemistry
9. BS3171 BSC 0 0 4 4 2
Laboratory
10. GE3172 English Laboratory $ EEC 0 0 2 2 1
TOTAL 16 1 10 27 22
$ Skill Based Course
SEMESTER II
PERIODS TOTAL
SI. COURSE CATE- PERWEEK
COURSETITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
THEORY
1. HS3252 Professional English - II HSMC 2 0 0 2 2
2. MA3251 Statistics and Numerical Methods BSC 3 1 0 4 4
3. PH3257 Physics for Textile Technologists BSC 3 0 0 3 3
4. Basic Electrical, Electronics and
BE3252 ESC 3 0 0 3 3
Instrumentation Engineering
5. GE3251 Engineering Graphics ESC 2 0 4 6 4
6. CY3252 Chemistry for Textile
BSC 3 0 0 3 3
Technologists
7. GE3252 /
HSMC 1 0 0 1 1
Tamils and Technology
8. NCC Credit Course Level 1# - 2 0 0 2 2
PRACTICALS
9. GE3271 Engineering Practices Laboratory ESC 0 0 4 4 2
10. Basic Electrical, Electronics and
BE3272 Instrumentation Engineering ESC 0 0 4 4 2
Laboratory
11. Communication Laboratory /
GE3272 EEC 0 0 4 4 2
Foreign Language $
TOTAL 17 1 16 34 26
# NCC Credit Course level 1 is offered for NCC students only. The grades earned by the
students will be recorded in the Mark Sheet, however the same shall not be considered for the computation of CGPA.
$ Skill Based Course
8
SEMESTER III
PERIODS TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE PER WEEK
COURSE TITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
THEORY
1. MA3357 Probability
BSC 3 1 0 4 4
and Statistical Methods
2. TT3301 Engineering Mechanics for
ESC 3 1 0 4 4
Textile Technologists
3. TT3354 Technology of Pre-Spinning
PCC 3 0 0 3 3
Process
4. TT3351 Preparatory process for
PCC 3 0 2 5 4
woven Fabric Manufacture
5. TT3353 Structure and Properties of
PCC 3 0 2 5 4
Textile Fibres
6. TT3352 Production of Textile Fibres PCC 3 0 0 3 3
PRACTICALS
7. TT3361 Pre Spinning Laboratory PCC 0 0 3 3 1.5
8. GE3361 Professional Development$ EEC 0 0 2 2 1
TOTAL 18 2 9 29 24.5
$ Skill Based Course
SEMESTER IV
PERIODS TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE PER WEEK
COURSE TITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
THEORY
1. TT3454 Technology of Yarn Spinning PCC 3 0 2 5 4
2. TT3453 Technology of woven Fabric
PCC 3 0 0 3 3
Manufacture
3. TT3452 Knitting Technology PCC 3 0 0 3 3
4. TT3451 Chemical Processing of
PCC 3 0 0 3 3
Textile Materials I
5. TT3401 Woven Fabric Structure and
PCC 3 0 0 3 3
Design
6. GE3451 Environmental Sciences and
BSC 2 0 0 2 2
Sustainability
7. NCC Credit Course Level 2# 3 0 0 3 3#
PRACTICALS
8. TT3461 Fabric Manufacture PCC
0 0 3 3 1.5
Laboratory
9. TT3462 Fabric Structure Analysis PCC
0 0 3 3 1.5
Laboratory
10. TT3511 Industrial Training/Internship EEC
- - - - -
I*
TOTAL 17 0 8 25 21
# NCC Credit Course level 2 is offered for NCC students only. The grades earned by the students will be recorded in the
Mark Sheet, however the same shall not be considered for the computation of CGPA.
*Four weeks industrial training/internship carries two credits. Industrial training/internship during IV Semester Summer
Vacation will be evaluated in V semester
9
SEMESTER V
PERIODS TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE PER WEEK
COURSE TITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
THEORY
1. TT3591 Testing of Textile Materials PCC 3 0 0 3 3
2. Professional Elective I PEC 3 0 0 3 3
3. Professional Elective II PEC 3 0 0 3 3
4. Professional Elective III PEC 3 0 0 3 3
5. Professional Elective IV PEC 3 0 0 3 3
6. Mandatory Course-I& Non-Credit
MC 3 0 0 3
Course
PRACTICALS
7. TT3511 Industrial Training/Internship EEC
0 0 0 0 2
I*
8. TT3581 Testing of Textiles Materials
PCC 0 0 3 3 1.5
Laboratory
TOTAL 18 0 3 21 18.5
&
Mandatory Course-I is a Non-credit Course (Student shall select one course from the list given under MC-I)
*Four weeks industrial training/internship carries two credits. Industrial training/internship during IV Semester Summer
Vacation will be evaluated in V semester
SEMESTER VI
PERIODS TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE PER WEEK
COURSE TITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
THEORY
1. TT3651 Chemical Processing of
PCC 3 0 0 3 3
Textile Material II
2. TT3691 Technology of Nonwoven PCC 3 0 0 3 3
3. TT3601 Mechanics of Textile
PCC 3 0 0 3 3
Machinery
4. Open Elective – I* OEC 3 0 0 3 3
5. Professional Elective V PEC 3 0 0 3 3
6. Professional Elective VI PEC 3 0 0 3 3
7. NCC Credit Course Level 3# 3 0 0 3 3#
8. Non-Credit
Mandatory Course-II& MC 3 0 0 3
Course
PRACTICALS
9. TT3661 Textile Chemical Processing
PCC 0 0 3 3 1.5
Laboratory
10. TT3611 Textile Product Engineering PCC 0 0 3 3
1.5
Laboratory
11. TT3711 Industrial Training/Internship EEC
- - - - -
II##
TOTAL 21 0 6 27 21
*Open Elective – I shall be chosen from the emerging technologies.
##
Four weeks industrial training/internship carries two credits. Industrial training/Internship during VI Semester Summer
Vacation will be evaluated in VII semester
&
Mandatory Course-II is a Non-credit Course (Student shall select one course from the list given under MC- II)
#
NCC Credit Course level 3 is offered for NCC students only. The grades earned by the students will be recorded
10
in the Mark Sheet, however the same shall not be considered for the computation of CGPA.
SEMESTER VII/VIII*
PERIODS TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE PER WEEK
COURSE TITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
THEORY
1. TT3751 Apparel and Home
PCC 3 0 2 5 4
Furnishings Manufacture
2. TT3752 Financial Management for
PCC 3 0 0 3 3
Textile Industries
3. GE3791 Human values and Ethics HSMC 2 0 0 2 2
4. Elective- Management # HSMC 3 0 0 3 3
5. Open Elective – II** OEC 3 0 0 3 3
6. Open Elective – III*** OEC 3 0 0 3 3
7. Open Elective – IV*** OEC 3 0 0 3 3
PRACTICALS
8. TT3711 Industrial Training/ EEC
- - - - 2
Internship II##
TOTAL 20 0 2 22 23
*If students undergo internship in Semester VII, then the courses offered during semester VII will be offered
during semester VIII.
**Open Elective – II shall be chosen from the emerging technologies.
***Open Elective III and IV (Shall be chosen from the list of open electives offered by other Programmes
#
Elective- Management shall be chosen from the Elective Management courses
##
Four weeks industrial training/internship carries two credits. Industrial training/Internship during VI Semester Summer
Vacation will be evaluated in VII semester
SEMESTER VIII/VII*
PERIODS TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE PER WEEK
COURSE TITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
THEORY
1. TT3811 Project Work / Internship# EEC 0 0 20 20 10
TOTAL 0 0 20 20 10
*If students undergo internship in Semester VII, then the courses offered during semester VII will be offered
during semester VIII.
#
15 weeks of continuous Internship in an organization carries 10 credits.
TOTAL CREDITS: 166
11
ELECTIVE – MANAGEMENT COURSES
MANDATORY COURSES I*
PERIODS TOTAL
S. CATE
COURSE COURSE TITLE PER WEEK CONTACT
NO. GORY
CODE L T P PERIODS
1. MX3081 Introduction to Women and MC 3 0 0 3
Gender Studies
2. MX3082 Elements of Literature MC 3 0 0 3
3. MX3083 Film Appreciation MC 3 0 0 3
4. MX3084 Disaster Risk Reduction and MC 3 0 0 3
Management
PERIODS TOTAL
S. COURSE CATE
COURSE TITLE PER WEEK CONTACT
NO. CODE GORY
L T P PERIODS
1. MX3085 Well Being with Traditional MC 3 0 0 3
Practices -Yoga, Ayurveda
and Siddha
2. MX3086 History of Science and MC 3 0 0 3
Technology in India
3. MX3087 Political and Economic MC 3 0 0 3
Thought for a Humane
Society
4. MX3088 State, Nation Building and MC 3 0 0 3
Politics in India
5. MX3089 Industrial Safety MC 3 0 0 3
* Mandatory Courses are offered as Non –Credit Courses
12
PROFESSIONAL ELECTIVE COURSES : VERTICALS
Vertical III
Vertical I Vertical II Vertical IV Vertical V
Management
Spinning, Weaving Garment Technical Advancements
of Textile
and chemical Manufacturing Textiles in textiles
Industries
processing
Process and Quality Garment Production Operations Technical Characterization
Control in Spinning Machinery Research in Textiles of Textile
Textile Polymers
Industry
Process and Quality Industrial Engineering Supply Chain Medical Clothing Comfort
Control in Fabric in Garment Industry Management Textiles
Manufacture
Theory of Drafting Pattern Engineering Apparel Home Textile
and Twisting Costing Textiles Reinforced
Composites
Production and Apparel Marketing and Textile and Smart High
application of sewing Merchandising Apparel EXIM Textiles Performance
threads Management Fibres
Structural Mechanics Apparel Product Enterprise Protective Advanced
of Yarns and Fabrics Development Resource Textiles Testing of
Laboratory Planning for Textiles
Garment
Industry
Textile Chemicals Basic Sewing and Management Coated Advances in
and Auxiliaries Pattern Making of Textile Textiles Textile Printing
Laboratory Effluents and Finishes
13
PROFESSIONAL ELECTIVE COURSES : VERTICALS
14
VERTICAL III: MANAGEMENT OF TEXTILE INDUSTRIES
15
OPEN ELECTIVES
(Students shall choose the open elective courses, such that the course contents are not similar to
any other course contents/title under other course categories.
16
14. OML351 Introduction to non- OEC 3 0 0 3 3
destructive testing
15. OMR351 Mechatronics OEC 3 0 0 3 3
16. ORA351 Foundation of OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Robotics
17. OAE352 Fundamentals of OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Aeronautical
engineering
18. OGI351 Remote Sensing OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Concepts
19. OAI351 Urban Agriculture OEC 3 0 0 3 3
20. OEN351 Drinking Water Supply OEC 3 0 0 3 3
and Treatment
21. OEE352 Electric Vehicle OEC 3 0 0 3 3
technology
22. OEI353 Introduction to PLC OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Programming
23. OFD352 Traditional Indian OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Foods
24. OFD353 Introduction to food OEC 3 0 0 3 3
processing
25. OPY352 IPR for Pharma OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Industry
26. OCH351 Nano Technology OEC 3 0 0 3 3
27. OCH352 Functional Materials OEC 3 0 0 3 3
28. OPE351 Introduction to OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Petroleum Refining
and Petrochemicals
29. CPE334 Energy Conservation OEC 3 0 0 3 3
and Management
30. OPT351 Basics of Plastics OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Processing
31. OEC351 Signals and Systems OEC 3 0 0 3 3
32. OEC352 Fundamentals of OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Electronic Devices and
Circuits
33. CBM348 Foundation Skills in OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Integrated Product
Development
34. CBM333 Assistive Technology OEC 3 0 0 3 3
35. OMA352 Operations Research OEC 3 0 0 3 3
36. OMA353 Algebra and Number OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Theory
37. OMA354 Linear Algebra OEC 3 0 0 3 3
38. OBT352 Basics of Microbial OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Technology
39. OBT353 Basics of OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Biomolecules
40. OBT354 Fundamentals of Cell OEC 3 0 0 3 3
and Molecular Biology
17
OPEN ELECTIVES – IV
COURSE PERIODS TOTAL
SL. CATE PER WEEK
CODE COURSE TITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO. GORY
L T P PERIODS
1. OHS352 Project Report Writing OEC 3 0 0 3 3
2. OCE354 Basics of Integrated OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Water Resources
Management
3. OMA355 Advanced Numerical OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Methods
4. OMA356 Random Processes OEC 3 0 0 3 3
5. OMA357 Queuing and OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Reliability Modelling
6. OMG354 Production and OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Operations
Management for
Entrepreneurs
7. OMG355 Multivariate Data OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Analysis
8. OME352 Additive Manufacturing OEC 3 0 0 3 3
9. CME343 New Product OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Development
10. OME355 Industrial Design & OEC 2 0 2 4 3
Rapid Prototyping
Techniques
11. MF3010 Micro and Precision OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Engineering
12. OMF354 Cost Management of OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Engineering Projects
13. AU3002` Batteries and OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Management system
14. AU3008 Sensors and Actuators OEC 3 0 0 3 3
15. OAS353 Space Vehicles OEC 3 0 0 3 3
16. OIM352 Management Science OEC 3 0 0 3 3
17. OIM353 Production Planning OEC 3 0 0 3 3
and Control
18. OIE353 Operations OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Management
19. OSF352 Industrial Hygiene OEC 3 0 0 3 3
20. OSF353 Chemical Process OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Safety
21. OML352 Electrical, Electronic OEC 3 0 0 3 3
and Magnetic
materials
22. OML353 Nanomaterials and OEC 3 0 0 3 3
applications
23. OMR352 Hydraulics and OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Pneumatics
24. OMR353 Sensors OEC 3 0 0 3 3
25. ORA352 Concepts in Mobile OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Robots
18
26. MV3501 Marine Propulsion OEC 3 0 0 3 3
27. OMV351 Marine Merchant OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Vessels
28. OMV352 Elements of Marine OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Engineering
29. CRA332 Drone Technologies OEC 3 0 0 3 3
30. OGI352 Geographical OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Information System
31. OAI352 Agriculture OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Entrepreneurship
Development
32. OEN352 Biodiversity OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Conservation
33. OEE353 Introduction to control OEC 3 0 0 3 3
systems
34. OEI354 Introduction to OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Industrial Automation
Systems
35. OFD354 Fundamentals of Food OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Engineering
36. OFD355 Food safety and OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Quality Regulations
37. OPY353 Nutraceuticals OEC 3 0 0 3 3
38. OCH353 Energy Technology OEC 3 0 0 3 3
39. OCH354 Surface Science OEC 3 0 0 3 3
40. OPE353 Industrial safety OEC 3 0 0 3 3
41. OPE354 Unit Operations in OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Petro Chemical
Industries
42. OPT352 Plastic Materials for OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Engineers
43. OPT353 Properties and Testing OEC 3 0 0 3 3
of Plastics
44. OEC353 VLSI Design OEC 3 0 0 3 3
45. CBM370 Wearable devices OEC 3 0 0 3 3
46. CBM356 Medical Informatics OEC 3 0 0 3 3
47. OBT355 Biotechnology for OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Waste Management
48. OBT356 Lifestyle Diseases OEC 3 0 0 3 3
49. OBT357 Biotechnology in OEC 3 0 0 3 3
Health Care
19
SUMMARY
Non-Credit
8 √ √
/(Mandatory)
20
Enrollment for B.E. / B. Tech. (Honours) / Minor degree (Optional)
A student can also optionally register for additional courses (18 credits) and become eligible for
the award of B.E./B.Tech. (Honours) Minor degree.
For B.E. / B. Tech. (Honours), a student shall register for the additional courses (18 credits) from
semester V onwards. These courses shall be from the same vertical or a combination of different
verticals of the same programme of study only.
For minor degree, a student shall register for the additional courses (18 credits) from semester V
onwards. All these courses have to be in a particular vertical from any one of the other
programmes, Moreover, for minor degree the student can register for courses from any one of the
following verticals also.
Complete details are available in clause 4.10 (Amendments) of Regulations 2021.
VERTICALS FOR MINOR DEGREE (IN ADDITIONS TO ALL THE VERTICALS OF OTHER
PROGRAMMES)
Vertical IV
Vertical I Vertical III Business Vertical V
Vertical II
Fintech and Public Data Environment and
Entrepreneurship
Block Chain Administration Analytics Sustainability
21
(Choice of courses for Minor degree is to be made from any one vertical of other
programmes or from anyone of the following verticals)
SL PERIODS
COURSE TOTAL
. CATE PER WEEK
CODE COURSE TITLE CONTACT CREDITS
NO GORY
L T P PERIODS
.
1. CMG331 Financial Management PEC 3 0 0 3 3
2. CMG332 Fundamentals of
PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Investment
3. CMG333 Banking, Financial
PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Services and Insurance
4. CMG334 Introduction to
Blockchain and its PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Applications
5. CMG335 Fintech Personal
PEC 3 0 0 3 3
Finance and Payments
6. CMG336 Introduction to Fintech PEC 3 0 0 3 3
VERTICAL 2: ENTREPRENEURSHIP
22
VERTICAL 3: PUBLIC ADMINISTRATION
23
VERTICAL 5: ENVIRONMENT AND SUSTAINABILITY
24
IP3151 INDUCTION PROGRAMME
This is a mandatory 2 week programme to be conducted as soon as the students enter the
institution. Normal classes start only after the induction program is over.
The induction programme has been introduced by AICTE with the following objective:
“One will have to work closely with the newly joined students in making them feel comfortable,
allow them to explore their academic interests and activities, reduce competition and make them
work for excellence, promote bonding within them, build relations between teachers and students,
give a broader view of life, and build character. “
Hence, the purpose of this programme is to make the students feel comfortable in their new
environment, open them up, set a healthy daily routine, create bonding in the batch as well as
between faculty and students, develop awareness, sensitivity and understanding of the self,
people around them, society at large, and nature.
The following are the activities under the induction program in which the student would be fully
engaged throughout the day for the entire duration of the program.
25
This would address some lacunas that students might have, for example, English, computer
familiarity etc.
Induction Programme is totally an activity based programme and therefore there shall be
no tests / assessments during this programme.
References:
Guide to Induction program from AICTE
UNIT V EXPRESSION 9
Reading – Reading editorials; and Opinion Blogs; Writing – Essay Writing (Descriptive or
narrative). Grammar – Future Tenses, Punctuation; Negation (Statements & Questions); and
Simple, Compound & Complex Sentences. Vocabulary - Cause & Effect Expressions – Content vs
Function words.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
LEARNING OUTCOMES :
At the end of the course, learners will be able
To use appropriate words in a professional context
To gain understanding of basic grammatical structures and use them in right context.
To read and interpret information presented in tables, charts and other graphic forms
To write definitions, descriptions, narrations and essays on various topics
TEXT BOOKS :
1. English for Engineers & Technologists Orient Blackswan Private Ltd. Department of
English, Anna University, (2020 edition)
2. English for Science & Technology Cambridge University Press, 2021.
Authored by Dr. Veena Selvam, Dr. Sujatha Priyadarshini, Dr. Deepa Mary Francis, Dr.
KN. Shoba, and Dr. Lourdes Joevani, Department of English, Anna University.
REFERENCE BOOKS:
1. Technical Communication – Principles And Practices By Meenakshi Raman & Sangeeta
Sharma, Oxford Univ. Press, 2016, New Delhi.
2. A Course Book On Technical English By Lakshminarayanan, Scitech Publications (India)
Pvt. Ltd.
27
3. English For Technical Communication (With CD) By Aysha Viswamohan, Mcgraw Hill
Education, ISBN : 0070264244.
4. Effective Communication Skill, Kulbhusan Kumar, RS Salaria, Khanna Publishing House.
5. Learning to Communicate – Dr. V. Chellammal, Allied Publishing House, New Delhi,2003.
ASSESSMENT PATTERN
Two internal assessments and an end semester examination to test students’ reading and writing
skills along with their grammatical and lexical competence.
28
UNIT IV INTEGRAL CALCULUS 9+3
Definite and Indefinite integrals - Substitution rule - Techniques of Integration : Integration by parts,
Trigonometric integrals, Trigonometric substitutions, Integration of rational functions by partial
fraction, Integration of irrational functions - Improper integrals - Applications : Hydrostatic force
and pressure, moments and centres of mass.
TEXT BOOKS :
1. Kreyszig.E, "Advanced Engineering Mathematics", John Wiley and Sons,
10th Edition, New Delhi, 2016.
2. Grewal.B.S., “Higher Engineering Mathematics”, Khanna Publishers, New Delhi,
44th Edition , 2018.
3. James Stewart, " Calculus : Early Transcendentals ", Cengage Learning, 8th Edition, New
Delhi, 2015. [For Units II & IV - Sections 1.1, 2.2, 2.3, 2.5, 2.7 (Tangents problems
only), 2.8, 3.1 to 3.6, 3.11, 4.1, 4.3, 5.1 (Area problems only), 5.2, 5.3, 5.4 (excluding net
change theorem), 5.5, 7.1 - 7.4 and 7.8 ].
REFERENCES :
1. Anton. H, Bivens. I and Davis. S, " Calculus ", Wiley, 10th Edition, 2016
2. Bali. N., Goyal. M. and Watkins. C., “ Advanced Engineering Mathematics ”, Firewall
Media (An imprint of Lakshmi Publications Pvt., Ltd.,), New Delhi, 7th Edition, 2009.
3. Jain . R.K. and Iyengar. S.R.K., “ Advanced Engineering Mathematics ”, Narosa
Publications, New Delhi, 5th Edition, 2016.
4. Narayanan. S. and Manicavachagom Pillai. T. K., “ Calculus " Volume I and II,
S. Viswanathan Publishers Pvt. Ltd., Chennai, 2009.
5. Ramana. B.V., " Higher Engineering Mathematics ", McGraw Hill Education Pvt. Ltd,
New Delhi, 2016.
6. Srimantha Pal and Bhunia. S.C, " Engineering Mathematics " Oxford University Press,
2015.
7. Thomas. G. B., Hass. J, and Weir. M.D, " Thomas Calculus ", 14th Edition, Pearson India,
2018.
UNIT I MECHANICS 9
Multi-particle dynamics: Center of mass (CM) – CM of continuous bodies – motion of the CM –
kinetic energy of system of particles. Rotation of rigid bodies: Rotational kinematics – rotational
kinetic energy and moment of inertia - theorems of M .I –moment of inertia of continuous bodies –
M.I of a diatomic molecule - torque – rotational dynamics of rigid bodies – conservation of angular
momentum – rotational energy state of a rigid diatomic molecule - gyroscope - torsional pendulum
– double pendulum –Introduction to nonlinear oscillations.
30
TEXT BOOKS:
1. D.Kleppner and R.Kolenkow. An Introduction to Mechanics. McGraw Hill Education (Indian
Edition), 2017.
2. E.M.Purcell and D.J.Morin, Electricity and Magnetism, Cambridge Univ.Press, 2013.
3. Arthur Beiser, Shobhit Mahajan, S. Rai Choudhury, Concepts of Modern Physics, McGraw-
Hill (Indian Edition), 2017.
REFERENCES:
1. R.Wolfson. Essential University Physics. Volume 1 & 2. Pearson Education (Indian
Edition), 2009.
2. Paul A. Tipler, Physic – Volume 1 & 2, CBS, (Indian Edition), 2004.
3. K.Thyagarajan and A.Ghatak. Lasers: Fundamentals and Applications, Laxmi Publications,
(Indian Edition), 2019.
4. D.Halliday, R.Resnick and J.Walker. Principles of Physics, Wiley (Indian Edition), 2015.
5. N.Garcia, A.Damask and S.Schwarz. Physics for Computer Science Students. Springer-
Verlag,
31
UNIT II NANOCHEMISTRY 9
Basics: Distinction between molecules, nanomaterials and bulk materials; Size-dependent
properties (optical, electrical, mechanical and magnetic); Types of nanomaterials: Definition,
properties and uses of – nanoparticle, nanocluster, nanorod, nanowire and nanotube. Preparation
of nanomaterials: sol-gel, solvothermal, laser ablation, chemical vapour deposition,
electrochemical deposition and electro spinning. Applications of nanomaterials in medicine,
agriculture, energy, electronics and catalysis.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. P. C. Jain and Monica Jain, “Engineering Chemistry”, 17th Edition, Dhanpat Rai Publishing
Company (P) Ltd, New Delhi, 2018.
2. Sivasankar B., “Engineering Chemistry”, Tata McGraw-Hill Publishing Company Ltd, New
Delhi, 2008.
3. S.S. Dara, “A Text book of Engineering Chemistry”, S. Chand Publishing, 12 th Edition,
2018.
32
REFERENCES:
1. B. S. Murty, P. Shankar, Baldev Raj, B. B. Rath and James Murday, “Text book of
nanoscience and nanotechnology”, Universities Press-IIM Series in Metallurgy and
Materials Science, 2018.
2. O.G. Palanna, “Engineering Chemistry” McGraw Hill Education (India) Private Limited, 2nd
Edition, 2017.
3. Friedrich Emich, “Engineering Chemistry”, Scientific International PVT, LTD, New Delhi,
2014.
4. ShikhaAgarwal, “Engineering Chemistry-Fundamentals and Applications”, Cambridge
University Press, Delhi, Second Edition, 2019.
5. O.V. Roussak and H.D. Gesser, Applied Chemistry-A Text Book for Engineers and
Technologists, Springer Science Business Media, New York, 2nd Edition, 2013.
34
GE3152 LTPC
1 001
I : 3
– – –
- –
–
– -
– –
–
II – –
: 3
– –
–
– – –
– –
–
III : 3
IV : 3
–
–
– –
–
–
V
: 3
–
– –
– -
TOTAL : 15 PERIODS
TEXT-CUM-REFERENCE BOOKS
1. – –
).
2. –
3. –
4. –
5. Social Life of Tamils (Dr.K.K.Pillay) A joint publication of TNTB & ESC and RMRL – (in
35
print)
6. Social Life of the Tamils - The Classical Period (Dr.S.Singaravelu) (Published by:
International Institute of Tamil Studies.
7. Historical Heritage of the Tamils (Dr.S.V.Subatamanian, Dr.K.D. Thirunavukkarasu)
(Published by: International Institute of Tamil Studies).
8. The Contributions of the Tamils to Indian Culture (Dr.M.Valarmathi) (Published by:
International Institute of Tamil Studies.)
9. Keeladi - ‘Sangam City C ivilization on the banks of river Vaigai’ (Jointly Published by:
Department of Archaeology & Tamil Nadu Text Book and Educational Services Corporation,
Tamil Nadu)
10. Studies in the History of India with Special Reference to Tamil Nadu (Dr.K.K.Pillay)
(Published by: The Author)
11. Porunai Civilization (Jointly Published by: Department of Archaeology & Tamil Nadu Text
Book and Educational Services Corporation, Tamil Nadu)
12. Journey of Civilization Indus to Vaigai (R.Balakrishnan) (Published by: RMRL) – Reference
Book.
36
2. – . .( ).
3. – (
)
4. – .( )
5. Social Life of Tamils (Dr.K.K.Pillay) A joint publication of TNTB & ESC and RMRL – (in
print)
6. Social Life of the Tamils - The Classical Period (Dr.S.Singaravelu) (Published by:
International Institute of Tamil Studies.
7. Historical Heritage of the Tamils (Dr.S.V.Subatamanian, Dr.K.D. Thirunavukkarasu)
(Published by: International Institute of Tamil Studies).
8. The Contributions of the Tamils to Indian Culture (Dr.M.Valarmathi) (Published by:
International Institute of Tamil Studies.)
9. Keeladi - ‘Sangam City C ivilization on the banks of river Vaigai’ (Jointly Published by:
Department of Archaeology & Tamil Nadu Text Book and Educational Services Corporation,
Tamil Nadu)
10. Studies in the History of India with Special Reference to Tamil Nadu (Dr.K.K.Pillay)
(Published by: The Author)
11. Porunai Civilization (Jointly Published by: Department of Archaeology & Tamil Nadu Text
Book and Educational Services Corporation, Tamil Nadu)
12. Journey of Civilization Indus to Vaigai (R.Balakrishnan) (Published by: RMRL) – Reference
Book.
EXPERIMENTS:
Note: The examples suggested in each experiment are only indicative. The lab instructor is
expected to design other problems on similar lines. The Examination shall not be restricted to the
sample experiments listed here.
1. Identification and solving of simple real life or scientific or technical problems, and
developing flow charts for the same. (Electricity Billing, Retail shop billing, Sin series, weight
of a motorbike, Weight of a steel bar, compute Electrical Current in Three Phase AC Circuit,
etc.)
2. Python programming using simple statements and expressions (exchange the values of two
variables, circulate the values of n variables, distance between two points).
3. Scientific problems using Conditionals and Iterative loops. (Number series, Number Patterns,
pyramid pattern)
4. Implementing real-time/technical applications using Lists, Tuples. (Items present in a
library/Components of a car/ Materials required for construction of a building –operations of
list & tuples)
5. Implementing real-time/technical applications using Sets, Dictionaries. (Language,
components of an automobile, Elements of a civil structure, etc.- operations of Sets &
Dictionaries)
6. Implementing programs using Functions. (Factorial, largest number in a list, area of shape)
37
7. Implementing programs using Strings. (reverse, palindrome, character count, replacing
characters)
8. Implementing programs using written modules and Python Standard Libraries (pandas,
numpy. Matplotlib, scipy)
9. Implementing real-time/technical applications using File handling. (copy from one file to
another, word count, longest word)
10. Implementing real-time/technical applications using Exception handling. (divide by zero error,
voter’s age validity, student mark range validation)
11. Exploring Pygame tool.
12. Developing a game activity using Pygame like bouncing ball, car race etc.
TOTAL: 60 PERIODS
OUTCOMES:
On completion of the course, students will be able to:
CO1: Develop algorithmic solutions to simple computational problems
CO2: Develop and execute simple Python programs.
CO3: Implement programs in Python using conditionals and loops for solving problems..
CO4: Deploy functions to decompose a Python program.
CO5: Process compound data using Python data structures.
CO6: Utilize Python packages in developing software applications.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Allen B. Downey, “Think Python : How to Think like a Computer Scientist”, 2nd Edition,
O’Reilly Publishers, 2016.
2. Karl Beecher, “Computational Thinking: A Beginner's Guide to Problem Solving and
Programming”, 1st Edition, BCS Learning & Development Limited, 2017.
REFERENCES:
1. Paul Deitel and Harvey Deitel, “Python for Programmers”, Pearson Education, 1st Edition,
2021.
2. G Venkatesh and Madhavan Mukund, “Computational Thinking: A Primer for Programmers
and Data Scientists”, 1st Edition, Notion Press, 2021.
3. John V Guttag, "Introduction to Computation and Programming Using Python: With
Applications to Computational Modeling and Understanding Data‘‘, Third Edition, MIT
Press , 2021
4. Eric Matthes, “Python Crash Course, A Hands - on Project Based Introduction to
Programming”, 2nd Edition, No Starch Press, 2019.
5. https://www.python.org/
6. Martin C. Brown, “Python: The Complete Reference”, 4th Edition, Mc-Graw Hill, 2018.
38
BS3171 PHYSICS AND CHEMISTRY LABORATORY L T P C
0 0 4 2
PHYSICS LABORATORY : (Any Seven Experiments)
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
To learn the proper use of various kinds of physics laboratory equipment.
To learn how data can be collected, presented and interpreted in a clear and concise
manner.
To learn problem solving skills related to physics principles and interpretation of
experimental data.
To determine error in experimental measurements and techniques used to minimize such
error.
To make the student as an active participant in each part of all lab exercises.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Torsional pendulum - Determination of rigidity modulus of wire and moment of inertia of
regular and irregular objects.
2. Simple harmonic oscillations of cantilever.
3. Non-uniform bending - Determination of Young’s modulus
4. Uniform bending – Determination of Young’s modulus
5. Laser- Determination of the wave length of the laser using grating
6. Air wedge - Determination of thickness of a thin sheet/wire
7. a) Optical fibre -Determination of Numerical Aperture and acceptance angle
b) Compact disc- Determination of width of the groove using laser.
8. Acoustic grating- Determination of velocity of ultrasonic waves in liquids.
9. Ultrasonic interferometer – determination of the velocity of sound and compressibility of
liquids
10. Post office box -Determination of Band gap of a semiconductor.
11. Photoelectric effect
12. Michelson Interferometer.
13. Melde’s string experiment
14. Experiment with lattice dynamics kit.
TOTAL: 30 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of the course, the students should be able to
CO1 : Understand the functioning of various physics laboratory equipment.
CO2 : Use graphical models to analyze laboratory data.
CO3 : Use mathematical models as a medium for quantitative reasoning and describing
physical reality.
CO4 : Access, process and analyze scientific information.
CO5 : Solve problems individually and collaboratively.
CO’s-PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 3 2 3 1 1 - - - - - - - - - -
2 3 3 2 1 1 - - - - - - - - - -
3 3 2 3 1 1 - - - - - - - - - -
4 3 3 2 1 1 - - - - - - - - - -
5 3 2 3 1 1 - - - - - - - - - -
AVG 3 2.4 2.6 1 1
1-Low,2-Medium,3-High,”-“-no correlation
Note: the average value of this course to be used for program articulation matrix.
39
CHEMISTRY LABORATORY: (Any seven experiments )
OBJECTIVES:
To inculcate experimental skills to test basic understanding of water quality parameters,
such as, acidity, alkalinity, hardness, DO, chloride and copper.
To induce the students to familiarize with electroanalytical techniques such as, pH metry,
potentiometry and conductometry in the determination of impurities in aqueous solutions.
To demonstrate the analysis of metals and alloys.
To demonstrate the synthesis of nanoparticles
TEXT BOOKS :
1. J. Mendham, R. C. Denney, J.D. Barnes, M. Thomas and B. Sivasankar, Vogel’s Textbook
of Quantitative Chemical Analysis (2009).
CO-PO & PSO MAPPING
PO PSO
CO
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 3 - 1 - - 2 2 - - - - 2 - - -
2 3 1 2 - - 1 2 - - - - 1 - - -
3 3 2 1 1 - - 1 - - - - - - - -
4 2 1 2 - - 2 2 - - - - - - - -
5 2 1 2 - 1 2 2 - - - - 1 - - -
Avg 2.6 1.3 1.6 1 1 1.4 1.8 - - - - 1.3 - - -
.
1-low, 2-medium, 3-high, ‘-“- no correlation
40
GE3172 ENGLISH LABORATORY L T P C
0 0 2 1
OBJECTIVES:
To improve the communicative competence of learners
To help learners use language effectively in academic /work contexts
To develop various listening strategies to comprehend various types of audio materials like
lectures, discussions, videos etc.
To build on students’ English language skills by engaging them in listening, speaking and
grammar learning activities that are relevant to authentic contexts.
To use language efficiently in expressing their opinions via various media.
UNIT V EXPRESSION 6
Listening – Listening to debates/ discussions; different viewpoints on an issue; and panel
discussions. Speaking –making predictions- talking about a given topic-giving opinions-
understanding a website-describing processes
TOTAL : 30 PERIODS
LEARNING OUTCOMES:
At the end of the course, learners will be able
To listen to and comprehend general as well as complex academic texts information
To listen to and understand different points of view in a discussion
To speak fluently and accurately in formal and informal communicative contexts
To describe products and processes and explain their uses and purposes clearly and
accurately
To express their opinions effectively in both formal and informal discussions
ASSESSMENT PATTERN
One online / app based assessment to test listening /speaking
End Semester ONLY listening and speaking will be conducted online.
41
Proficiency certification is given on successful completion of listening and speaking internal
test and end semester exam.
CO-PO & PSO MAPPING
PO PSO
CO
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 3 3 3 3 1 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 - - -
2 3 3 3 3 1 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 - - -
3 3 3 3 3 1 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 - - -
4 3 3 3 3 1 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 - - -
5 3 3 3 3 1 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 - - -
AVg. 3 3 3 3 1 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 - - -
1-low, 2-medium, 3-high, ‘-“- no correlation
Note: The average value of this course to be used for program articulation matrix.
Reading - Reading advertisements, user manuals, brochures; Writing – Professional emails, Email
etiquette - Compare and Contrast Essay; Grammar – Mixed Tenses, Prepositional phrases
42
OUTCOMES:
At the end of the course, learners will be able
To compare and contrast products and ideas in technical texts.
To identify and report cause and effects in events, industrial processes through technical
texts
To analyse problems in order to arrive at feasible solutions and communicate them in the
written format.
To present their ideas and opinions in a planned and logical manner
To draft effective resumes in the context of job search.
TEXT BOOKS :
1. English for Engineers & Technologists (2020 edition) Orient Blackswan Private Ltd.
Department of English, Anna University.
2. English for Science & Technology Cambridge University Press 2021.
3. Authored by Dr. Veena Selvam, Dr. Sujatha Priyadarshini, Dr. Deepa Mary Francis, Dr. KN.
Shoba, and Dr. Lourdes Joevani, Department of English, Anna University.
REFERENCE BOOKS:
1. Raman. Meenakshi, Sharma. Sangeeta (2019). Professional English. Oxford university press.
New Delhi.
2. Improve Your Writing ed. V.N. Arora and Laxmi Chandra, Oxford Univ. Press, 2001,
NewDelhi.
3. Learning to Communicate – Dr. V. Chellammal. Allied Publishers, New Delhi, 2003
4. Business Correspondence and Report Writing by Prof. R.C. Sharma & Krishna Mohan, Tata
McGraw Hill & Co. Ltd., 2001, New Delhi.
5. Developing Communication Skills by Krishna Mohan, Meera Bannerji- Macmillan India Ltd.
1990, Delhi.
ASSESSMENT PATTERN
Two internal assessments and an end semester examination to test students’ reading and writing
skills along with their grammatical and lexical competence.
43
To acquaint the knowledge of testing of hypothesis for small and large samples which
plays an important role in real life problems.
To introduce the basic concepts of solving algebraic and transcendental equations.
To introduce the numerical techniques of interpolation in various intervals and numerical
techniques of differentiation and integration which plays an important role in engineering
and technology disciplines.
To acquaint the knowledge of various techniques and methods of solving ordinary
differential equations.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Grewal, B.S., and Grewal, J.S., "Numerical Methods in Engineering and Science", Khanna
Publishers, 10th Edition, New Delhi, 2015.
2. Johnson, R.A., Miller, I and Freund J., “Miller and Freund’s Probability and Statistics for
Engineers", Pearson Education, Asia, 8th Edition, 2015.
44
REFERENCES:
1. Burden, R.L and Faires, J.D, "Numerical Analysis”, 9th Edition, Cengage Learning, 2016.
2. Devore. J.L., "Probability and Statistics for Engineering and the Sciences”, Cengage Learning,
New Delhi, 8th Edition, 2014.
3. Gerald. C.F. and Wheatley. P.O. "Applied Numerical Analysis” Pearson Education, Asia, New
Delhi, 7th Edition, 2007.
4. Gupta S.C. and Kapoor V. K., “ Fundamentals of Mathematical Statistics”, Sultan Chand &
Sons, New Delhi, 12th Edition, 2020.
5. Spiegel. M.R., Schiller. J. and Srinivasan. R.A., "Schaum’s Outlines on Probability and
Statistics ", Tata McGraw Hill Edition, 4th Edition, 2012.
6. Walpole. R.E., Myers. R.H., Myers. S.L. and Ye. K., “Probability and Statistics for Engineers
and Scientists", 9th Edition, Pearson Education, Asia, 2010.
PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PS
01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 O1 O2 O3
CO1 3 3 1 1 1 0 0 0 2 0 2 3 - - -
CO2 3 3 1 1 1 0 0 0 2 0 2 3 - - -
CO3 3 3 1 1 1 0 0 0 2 0 2 3 - - -
CO4 3 3 1 1 1 0 0 0 2 0 2 3 - - -
CO5 3 3 1 1 1 0 0 0 2 0 2 3 - - -
Avg 3 3 1 1 1 0 0 0 2 0 2 3 - - -
UNIT I CRYSTALLOGRAPHY 9
Crystal structures: Crystal lattice – basis - unit cell and lattice parameters – crystal systems and
Bravais lattices – Structure and packing fractions of SC, BCC, FCC, diamond cubic, NaCl, ZnS
structures – crystal planes, directions and Miller indices – distance between successive planes –
linear and planar densities – crystalline and noncrystalline materials –Example use of Miller
indices: wafer surface orientation – wafer flats and notches – pattern alignment - imperfections in
crystals.
45
UNIT III CERAMICS, COMPOSITES AND NANO MATERIALS 9
Ceramics – types and applications-refractories, abrasives and cements – Composites:
classification, role of matrix and reinforcement -Fiber reinforced composites – carbon-carbon
composites –Nanomaterials: types, physical, chemical and mechanical properties - carbon
nanotubes: properties and applications - synthesis of nanomaterials: sonochemical, molecular
epitaxy, physical vapor deposition (PVD) and chemical vapor deposition (CVD). Characterization:
Transmission electron microscopy - scanning electron microscopy - Atomic force microscopy - X-
ray powder diffraction - Nanoparticle size calculation.
UNIT IV MECHANICAL PROPERTIES 9
Tensile test - plastic deformation by slip – slip systems – mechanisms of strengthening in metals:
strain hardening, grain size reduction, solid solution strengthening, precipitation hardening –
Creep: creep curves,stress and temperature effects, mechanisms of creep, creep-resistant
materials – Fracture: ductile and brittle fractures - the Griffith criterion –fracture toughness -
Fatigue failure:the S-N curve – factors that affect fatigue life – Hardness: Rockwell and Brinell
hardness tests, Knoop and Vickers microhardness tests.
REFERENCES:
1. J.F.Shackelford. Introduction to Materials Science for Engineers. Pearson, 2015.
2. Wendelin Wright and Donald Askeland, Essentials of Materials Science and Engineering,
CL Engineering, 2013.
3. William Smith and Javad Hashemi, Foundations of Materials Science and Engineering, Mc
Graw-Hill Education, 2018.
4. Rajesh Mishra and Jiri Militky, Nanotechnology in Textiles: Theory and Application,
Elsevier, 2018.
5. Mark Fox, Optical Properties of Solids, Oxford Univ. Press, 2012.
46
BE3252 BASIC ELECTRICAL, ELECTRONICS AND INSTRUMENTATION LTPC
ENGINEERING 3 003
OBJECTIVES:
To introduce the basics of electric circuits and analysis
To impart knowledge in domestic wiring
To impart knowledge in the basics of working principles and application of electrical
machines
To introduce analog devices and their characteristics
To introduce the functional elements and working of sensors and transducers.
47
TEXT BOOKS:
1. D P Kothari and I.J Nagarath, “Basic Electrical and Electronics Engineering”, McGraw Hill
Education (India) Private Limited, Second Edition, 2020
2. A.K. Sawhney, Puneet Sawhney ‘A Course in Electrical & Electronic
Measurements & Instrumentation’, Dhanpat Rai and Co, 2015.
3. S.K. Bhattacharya, Basic Electrical Engineering, Pearson Education, 2019
4. James A Svoboda, Richard C. Dorf, Dorf’s Introduction to Electric Circuits,
Wiley, 2018.
REFERENCES:
1. John Bird, “Electrical Circuit theory and technology”, Routledge; 2017.
2. Thomas L. Floyd, ‘Electronic Devices’, 10th Edition, Pearson Education, 2018.
3. Albert Malvino, David Bates, ‘Electronic Principles, McGraw Hill Education; 7th edition,
2017
4. Muhammad H.Rashid, “Spice for Circuits and electronics”, 4th Edition.,Cengage India,
2019.
5. H.S. Kalsi, ‘Electronic Instrumentation’, Tata McGraw-Hill, New Delhi, 2010
TEXT BOOK:
1. Bhatt N.D. and Panchal V.M., “Engineering Drawing”, Charotar Publishing House,
rd
53 Edition, 2019.
2. Natrajan K.V., “A Text Book of Engineering Graphics”, Dhanalakshmi Publishers, Chennai, 2018.
3. Parthasarathy, N. S. and Vela Murali, “Engineering Drawing”, Oxford University Press, 2015
REFERENCES:
1. Basant Agarwal and Agarwal C.M., “Engineering Drawing”, McGraw Hill, 2 n d Edition, 2019.
2. Gopalakrishna K.R., “Engineering Drawing” (Vol. I&II combined), Subhas Publications, Bangalore,
27th Edition, 2017.
3. Luzzader, Warren.J. and Duff,John M., “Fundamentals of Engineering Drawing with an
introduction to Interactive Computer Graphics for Design and Production, Eastern Economy
Edition, Prentice Hall of India Pvt. Ltd, New Delhi, 2005.
49
4. Parthasarathy N. S. and Vela Murali, “Engineering Graphics”, Oxford University, Press, New Delhi,
2015.
5. Shah M.B., and Rana B.C., “Engineering Drawing”, Pearson Education India, 2nd Edition, 2009.
6. Venugopal K. and Prabhu Raja V., “Engineering Graphics", New Age International (P) Limited,
2008.
PO PSO
CO
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 3 1 2 2 3 2 2 2
2 3 1 2 2 3 2 2 2
3 3 1 2 2 3 2 2 2
4 3 1 2 2 3 2 2 2
5 3 1 2 2 3 2 2 2
Avg 3 1 2 2 3 2 2 2
Low (1) ; Medium (2) ; High (3)
50
UNIT II CHEMISTRY OF INTERFACES 9
Interface region-curved interfaces-thermodynamics of surfaces - Surface film on liquids-
Adsorption of gases on Solids-adsorption isotherms – types. Applications of adsorption studies-
detergency, wetting, foaming , de foaming, spreading, water repellency.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Dhara S. S., “A Text Book of Engineering Chemistry”, 12thEd., S. Chand & Co. Ltd., New
Delhi, 2016.
2. Jain. P.C. and Monica Jain, “Engineering Chemistry”, Dhanpet Rai & Sons, New Delhi, 17th
Edition, 2018.
3. Shikha Agarwal, “Engineering Chemistry-Fundamentals and Applications”, Cambridge
University Press, Delhi, 2019.
REFERENCES:
1. B.K. Sharma, “Industrial chemistry”, Krishna Prakashan Media (P) Ltd, Meerut, 2014.
2. Shore J., “Colourants and Auxiliaries: 2nd Edition, Volume 1 & 2, Wood head Publishing
Ltd., 2002.
3. Shenai V. A., “Chemistry of Dyes and Principles of Dyeing”, Sevak Publications, Mumbai,
1995.
51
4. Trotman E. R., “Dyeing and Chemical Technology of Textile Fibres”, B.Y Publishing Pvt.
Ltd., New Delhi, 1994.
GE3252 LTPC
1 0 01
I : 3
– -
–
II : 3
-
– -
–
–
-
– –
-
III : 3
– – –
– –
– –
– – – –
–
IV : 3
– –
– –
– –
– –
–
V : 3
– -
– –
– – –
TOTAL : 15 PERIODS
TEXT-CUM-REFERENCE BOOKS
1. – –
2. –
3. –
4. –
52
5. Social Life of Tamils (Dr.K.K.Pillay) A joint publication of TNTB & ESC and RMRL – (in print)
6. Social Life of the Tamils - The Classical Period (Dr.S.Singaravelu) (Published by:
International Institute of Tamil Studies.
7. Historical Heritage of the Tamils (Dr.S.V.Subatamanian, Dr.K.D. Thirunavukkarasu)
(Published by: International Institute of Tamil Studies).
8. The Contributions of the Tamils to Indian Culture (Dr.M.Valarmathi) (Published by:
International Institute of Tamil Studies.)
9. Keeladi - ‘Sangam City C ivilization on the banks of river Vaigai’ (Jointly Published by:
Department of Archaeology & Tamil Nadu Text Book and Educational Services Corporation,
Tamil Nadu)
10. Studies in the History of India with Special Reference to Tamil Nadu (Dr.K.K.Pillay)
(Published by: The Author)
11. Porunai Civilization (Jointly Published by: Department of Archaeology & Tamil Nadu Text
Book and Educational Services Corporation, Tamil Nadu)
12. Journey of Civilization Indus to Vaigai (R.Balakrishnan) (Published by: RMRL) – Reference
Book.
53
)
4. – .( )
5. Social Life of Tamils (Dr.K.K.Pillay) A joint publication of TNTB & ESC and RMRL – (in print)
6. Social Life of the Tamils - The Classical Period (Dr.S.Singaravelu) (Published by:
International Institute of Tamil Studies.
7. Historical Heritage of the Tamils (Dr.S.V.Subatamanian, Dr.K.D. Thirunavukkarasu)
(Published by: International Institute of Tamil Studies).
8. The Contributions of the Tamils to Indian Culture (Dr.M.Valarmathi) (Published by:
International Institute of Tamil Studies.)
9. Keeladi - ‘Sangam City C ivilization on the banks of river Vaigai’ (Jointly Published by:
Department of Archaeology & Tamil Nadu Text Book and Educational Services Corporation,
Tamil Nadu)
10. Studies in the History of India with Special Reference to Tamil Nadu (Dr.K.K.Pillay)
(Published by: The Author)
11. Porunai Civilization (Jointly Published by: Department of Archaeology & Tamil Nadu Text
Book and Educational Services Corporation, Tamil Nadu)
12. Journey of Civilization Indus to Vaigai (R.Balakrishnan) (Published by: RMRL) – Reference
Book.
54
NCC Credit Course Level 1*
NX3252 (NAVAL WING) NCC Credit Course Level - I L T P C
2 0 0 2
NCC GENERAL 6
NCC 1 Aims, Objectives & Organization of NCC 1
NCC 2 Incentives 2
NCC 3 Duties of NCC Cadet 1
NCC 4 NCC Camps: Types & Conduct 2
NATIONAL INTEGRATION AND AWARENESS 4
NI 1 National Integration: Importance & Necessity 1
NI 2 Factors Affecting National Integration 1
NI 3 Unity in Diversity & Role of NCC in Nation Building 1
NI 4 Threats to National Security
1
PERSONALITY DEVELOPMENT 7
PD 1 Self-Awareness, Empathy, Critical & Creative Thinking, Decision Making and Problem
Solving 2
PD 2 Communication Skills 3
PD 3 Group Discussion: Stress & Emotions 2
LEADERSHIP 5
L1 Leadership Capsule: Traits, Indicators, Motivation, Moral Values, Honour Code 3
L2 Case Studies: Shivaji, Jhasi Ki Rani 2
SOCIAL SERVICE AND COMMUNITY DEVELOPMENT 8
SS 1 Basics, Rural Development Programmes, NGOs, Contribution of Youth 3
SS 4 Protection of Children and Women Safety 1
SS 5 Road / Rail Travel Safety 1
SS 6 New Initiatives 2
SS 7 Cyber and Mobile Security Awareness 1
TOTAL : 30 PERIODS
NCC GENERAL 6
NCC 1 Aims, Objectives & Organization of NCC 1
NCC 2 Incentives 2
NCC 3 Duties of NCC Cadet 1
NCC 4 NCC Camps: Types & Conduct 2
NATIONAL INTEGRATION AND AWARENESS 4
NI 1 National Integration: Importance & Necessity 1
NI 2 Factors Affecting National Integration 1
NI 3 Unity in Diversity & Role of NCC in Nation Building 1
55
NI 4 Threats to National Security 1
PERSONALITY DEVELOPMENT 7
PD 1 Self-Awareness, Empathy, Critical & Creative Thinking, Decision Making and Problem
Solving 2
PD 2 Communication Skills 3
PD 3 Group Discussion: Stress & Emotions 2
LEADERSHIP 5
L1 Leadership Capsule: Traits, Indicators, Motivation, Moral Values, Honour Code 3
L2 Case Studies: Shivaji, Jhasi Ki Rani 2
SOCIAL SERVICE AND COMMUNITY DEVELOPMENT 8
SS 1 Basics, Rural Development Programmes, NGOs, Contribution of Youth 3
SS 4 Protection of Children and Women Safety 1
SS 5 Road / Rail Travel Safety 1
SS 6 New Initiatives 2
SS 7 Cyber and Mobile Security Awareness 1
TOTAL : 30 PERIODS
PLUMBING WORK:
a) Connecting various basic pipe fittings like valves, taps, coupling, unions,
reducers,elbows and other components which are commonly used in household.
b) Preparing plumbing line sketches.
c) Laying pipe connection to the suction side of a pump
d) Laying pipe connection to the delivery side of a pump.
e) Connecting pipes of different materials: Metal, plastic and flexible pipes used
inhousehold appliances.
WOOD WORK:
a) Sawing,
b) Planing and
c) Making joints like T-Joint, Mortise joint and Tenon joint and Dovetail joint.
56
b) Studying common industrial trusses using models.
a) Introduction to switches, fuses, indicators and lamps - Basic switch board wiring with lamp,
fan and three pin socket
b) Staircase wiring
c) Fluorescent Lamp wiring with introduction to CFL and LED types.
d) Energy meter wiring and related calculations/ calibration
e) Study of Iron Box wiring and assembly
f) Study of Fan Regulator (Resistor type and Electronic type using Diac/Triac/quadrac)
g) Study of emergency lamp wiring/Water heater
a) Welding of Butt Joints, Lap Joints, and Tee Joints using arc welding.
b) Practicing gas welding.
BASIC MACHINING WORK:
a) (simple)Turning.
b) (simple)Drilling.
c) (simple)Tapping.
ASSEMBLY WORK:
a) Assembling a centrifugal pump.
b) Assembling a household mixer.
c) Assembling an air conditioner.
FOUNDRY WORK:
a) Demonstrating basic foundry operations.
SOLDERING WORK:
a) Soldering simple electronic circuits and checking continuity.
57
CO1 : Draw pipe line plan; lay and connect various pipe fittings used in common household
plumbing work; Saw; plan; make joints in wood materials used in common household
wood work.
CO2 : Wire various electrical joints in common household electrical wire work.
CO3 :Weld various joints in steel plates using arc welding work; Machine various simple
processes like turning, drilling, tapping in parts; Assemble simple mechanical assembly of
common household equipments; Make a tray out of metal sheet using sheet metal work.
CO4 : Solder and test simple electronic circuits; Assemble and test simple
electronic components on PCB.
PO PSO
CO
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 3 2 1 1 1 2 2 1 1
2 3 2 1 1 1 2 2 1 1
3 3 2 1 1 1 2 2 1 1
Avg 3 2 1 1 1 2 2 1 1
Low (1) ; Medium (2) ; High (3)
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Verification of ohms and Kirchhoff’s Laws.
2. Three Phase Power Measurement
3. Load test on DC Shunt Motor.
4. Load test on Self Excited DC Generator
5. Load test on Single phase Transformer
6. Load Test on Induction Motor
7. Characteristics of PN and Zener Diodes
8. Characteristics of BJT, SCR and MOSFET
9. Design and analysis of Half wave and Full Wave rectifiers
10. Measurement of displacement of LVDT
. TOTAL: 60 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
After completing this course, the students will be able to
CO1: Use experimental methods to verify the Ohm’s law and Kirchhoff’s Law and to measure
three phase power
CO2: Analyze experimentally the load characteristics of electrical machines
CO3: Analyze the characteristics of basic electronic devices
CO4: Use LVDT to measure displacement
58
CO’s, PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
PO’s PSO’s
CO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 2 3 1 2 1.5 2 - - -
2 2 3 1 2 1.5 2 - - -
3 2 3 1 2 1.5 2 - - -
4 2 3 1 2 1.5 2 - - -
Avg. 1.6 1.4 0.8 1.6 1.2 1.6
UNIT I 12
Speaking-Role Play Exercises Based on Workplace Contexts, - talking about competition-
discussing progress toward goals-talking about experiences- talking about events in life-
discussing past events-Writing: writing emails ( formal & semi-formal).
UNIT II 12
Speaking: discussing news stories-talking about frequency-talking about travel problems-
discussing travel procedures- talking about travel problems- making arrangements-describing
arrangements-discussing plans and decisions- discussing purposes and reasons- understanding
common technology terms-Writing: - writing different types of emails.
UNIT III 12
Speaking: discussing predictions-describing the climate-discussing forecasts and scenarios-
talking about purchasing-discussing advantages and disadvantages- making comparisons-
discussing likes and dislikes- discussing feelings about experiences-discussing imaginary
scenarios Writing: short essays and reports-formal/semi-formal letters.
UNIT IV 12
Speaking: discussing the natural environment-describing systems-describing position and
movement- explaining rules-( example- discussing rental arrangements)- understanding technical
instructions-Writing: writing instructions-writing a short article.
UNIT V 12
Speaking: describing things relatively-describing clothing-discussing safety issues( making
recommendations) talking about electrical devices-describing controlling actions- Writing:
job application( Cover letter + Curriculum vitae)-writing recommendations.
TOTAL: 60 PERIODS
LEARNING OUTCOMES
At the end of the course, learners will be able
59
Speak effectively in group discussions held in a formal/semi formal contexts.
Discuss, analyse and present concepts and problems from various perspectives to arrive at
suitable solutions
Write emails, letters and effective job applications.
Write critical reports to convey data and information with clarity and precision
Give appropriate instructions and recommendations for safe execution of tasks
Assessment Pattern
One online / app based assessment to test speaking and writing skills
Proficiency certification is given on successful completion of speaking and writing.
60
UNIT – IV: CORRELATION, REGRESSION, INDEX NUMBERS AND TIMES
SERIES ANALYSIS 9+3
Correlation analysis, estimation of regression line. Time series analysis: Variations in time series,
trend analysis , cyclical variations , seasonal variations and irregular variations. Index Numbers –
Lasperyre’s, Paasche’s and Fisher’s Ideal Index.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Johnson, R.A., Miller, I and Freund J., "Miller and Freund’s Probability and Statistics for
Engineers", Pearson Education, Asia, 8th Edition, 2015.
2. Milton. J. S. and Arnold. J.C., "Introduction to Probability and Statistics", Tata McGraw Hill,
4th Edition, 2007.
3. Kreyszig.E, "Advanced Engineering Mathematics", John Wiley and Sons, 10 th Edition,
New Delhi, 2016.
4. Grewal.B.S., “Higher Engineering Mathematics”, Khanna Publishers, New Delhi, 44 th
Edition , 2018.
5. Richard I. Levin, David S. Rubin, Sanjay Rastogi Masood Husain Siddiqui, Statistics for
Management, Pearson Education, 7th Edition, 2016.
REFERENCES:
1. Devore. J.L., "Probability and Statistics for Engineering and the Sciences”, Cengage
Learning, New Delhi, 8th Edition, 2014.
2. Papoulis, A. and Unnikrishnapillai, S., "Probability, Random Variables and Stochastic
Processes", McGraw Hill Education India, 4th Edition, New Delhi, 2010.
3. Jain . R.K. and Iyengar. S.R.K., “ Advanced Engineering Mathematics ”, Narosa
Publications, New Delhi, 5 th Edition, 2016.
4. Ramana. B.V., " Higher Engineering Mathematics ", McGraw Hill Education Pvt. Ltd, New
Delhi, 2016.
5. Prem.S.Mann, “Introductory Statistics” 7th Edition, Wiley India, 2016.
6. Gareth James, Daniela Witten, Trevor Hastie, Robert Tibshirani, “An Introduction to
Statistical Learning with Applications in R”, Springer, 2016.
7. Aczel A.D. and Sounderpandian J., “Complete Business Statistics”, 6th edition, Tata
McGraw Hill Publishing Company Ltd., New Delhi, 2012.
PO01 PO02 PO03 PO04 PO05 PO06 PO07 PO08 PO09 PO10 PO11 PO12 PSO1 PSO2 PSO3
CO1 3 3 3 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 1 2 2 1 2
CO2 3 3 3 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 2 1 1 1 1
61
CO3 3 3 3 2 1 1 0 1 0 0 1 1 2 1 2
CO4 3 3 3 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 2 1
CO5 3 3 3 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 1 2 2 1 2
62
UNIT IV FRICTION (9+3)
The Laws of Dry Friction.Coefficients of Friction, Angles of Friction, Wedges, Wheel
Friction.Rolling Resistance, Ladder friction.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Beer Ferdinand P, Russel Johnston Jr., David F Mazurek, Philip J Cornwell,
SanjeevSanghi, Vector Mechanics for Engineers: Statics and Dynamics, McGraw Higher
Education., 11thEdition, 2017.
2. Vela Murali, “Engineering Mechanics-Statics and Dynamics”, Oxford University Press, 2018.
REFERENCES:
1. Boresi P and Schmidt J, Engineering Mechanics: Statics and Dynamics, 1/e, Cengage
learning, 2008.
2. Hibbeller, R.C., Engineering Mechanics: Statics, and Engineering Mechanics: Dynamics,
13th edition,Prentice Hall, 2013.
3. Irving H. Shames, Krishna Mohana Rao G, Engineering Mechanics – Statics and
Dynamics, 4thEdition,Pearson Education Asia Pvt. Ltd., 2005.
4. Meriam J L and Kraige L G, Engineering Mechanics: Statics and Engineering Mechanics:
Dynamics, 7thedition, Wiley student edition, 2013.
5. Timoshenko S, Young D H, Rao J V and Sukumar Pati, Engineering Mechanics
5thEdition, McGraw HillHigher Education, 2013.
63
Course Articulation Matrix:
Course Statement Program Outcome
Outcomes PO1 PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO PSO3
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2
CO1 Apply the various methods 3 3 3 2 2 1 1 - 1 1 1 2 2 2 1
to determine the resultant
forces and its equilibrium
acting on a particle in 2D and
3D
CO2 Apply the concept of reaction forces 3 3 3 2 2 1 1 - 1 1 1 2 2 2 1
(non-concurrent coplanar and
noncoplanar forces) and moment of
various support systems with rigid bodies
in 2D and 3D in equilibrium. Reducing
the force, moment, and couple to
an equivalent force - couple system
acting on rigid bodies in 2D and 3D
CO3 Apply the concepts of locating 3 3 3 2 2 1 1 - 1 1 1 2 2 2 1
centroids / center of gravity of
various sections / volumes and to
find out area moments of inertia
for the sections and mass
momentof inertia of solids.
CO4 Apply the concepts of frictional forces at 3 3 3 1 1 1 1 - 1 1 1 2 2 2 1
the contact surfaces of various
engineering systems.
CO5 Apply the various methods of 3 3 3 3 3 1 1 - 1 1 1 2 2 2 1
evaluating kinetic and kinematic
parameters of the rigid bodies
subjected to concurrent coplanar forces
Overall CO 3 3 3 2 2 1 1 - 1 1 1 2 2 2 1
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
64
TT3354 TECHNOLOGY OF PRE-SPINNING PROCESS LTPC
3003
OBJECTIVES:
To expose the students to the yarn numbering system used to specify textile yarns.
To enable the students to understand the processes involved in the production of yarn from
fibres.
To enable the students to understand the machinery used for the production of yarns using
short staple spinning system.
UNIT IV COMBING 9
Objectives of comber preparatory; detailed study of sliver lap, ribbon lap and super lap formers;
objectives and principle of combing; sequence of combing operation; combing efficiency and
production calculation.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Klein W., Vol. 1-3, “The Technology of Short Staple Spinning”, “A Practical Guide to Opening &
Carding” and “A Practical Guide to Combing, Drawing, and Roving frame”, The Textile Institute,
Manchester, U.K., 1998.
2. Chattopadhyay R. (Ed), Advances in Technology of Yarn Production, NCUTE, IIT Delhi, 2002.
3. Klein W., Vol.4 -5, “A Practical Guide to Ring Spinning, 1987” and “New Spinning Systems,
1993" The Textile Institute, Manchester, 1987.
4. Gowda R.V.M, “New Spinning Systems”, NCUTE, IIT Delhi, 2003.
65
REFERENCES:
1. Oxtoby E., “Spun Yarn Technology “, Butterworth, London, 1987
2. Klein W., “The Technology of Short-staple Spinning “, The Textile Institute, Manchester, 1998
3. Klein W., “A Practical Guide to Opening and Carding “, The Textile Institute, Manchester, 1999
4. Klein W., “A Practical Guide to Combing, Drawing and Roving Frame “, The Textile Institute,
Manchester, 1999
5. Lord P.R., “Yarn Production: Science, Technology and Economics “, The Textile Institute,
Manchester, 1999
6. Salhotra K.R. and Chattopadhyay R., “Book of papers on Blowroom and Card “, Indian Institute
of Technology, Delhi, 1998 41
7. Iredale J., “Yarn Preparation: A Handbook “, Intermediate Technology, 1992
8. Doraiswamy I., Chellamani P. and Pavendhan A., “Cotton Ginning, Textile Progress”, The
Textile Institute, Manchester, 1993.
66
Course Articulation Matrix:
67
TT3351 PREPARATORY PROCESS FOR WOVEN FABRIC MANUFACTURE LTPC
3024
OBJECTIVES:
The main objective of this course is to enable the students to understand the preparatory
processes involved in the production of fabrics.
UNIT I WINDING 13
Objects of winding; principles of cheese and cone winding machines; drum and precision winding;
uniform build of yarn package; types of drums – half accelerated and fully accelerated drums;
control of balloons; Classification of yarn faults and its removal; concepts in yarn clearing –
mechanical, optical and electronic clearers; knotters and splicers, weft winding; study of modern
automatic winders.
UNIT V DRAWING- IN 4
Need for drawing-in operation; manual and automatic drawing- in, leasing, knotting and pinning
machines; selection and care of reeds, healds and drop pins, control of cross ends and extra ends
and calculations.
TOTAL: 75 PERIODS (45L + 30P)
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS:
1. Analysis of Yarn faults
2. Control of production, package density, yarn faults in cone / cheese winding machine
3. Study of pirn winding
4. Study of warping machine
5. Study of sectional warping machine
6. Study of drawing – in, denting and tying
OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of the course, the students will be able to
CO1: Explain the types of winding, yarn faults and automatic winding
CO2: Elucidate winding package faults and winding performance
CO3: Discuss the types of warping and sizing process
CO4: Describe the process control in warping and sizing
CO5: Explain the manual and automatic drawing in process
CO6: Analyse yarn faults and control of faults in cone / cheese finding
CO7 Understand the preparatory process of fabric manufacturing by practice
68
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Sriramlu P.K., Ajgaonkar D.B. & Talukdar M.K., "Weaving Machines: Mechanisms,
Management", Mahajan Publishers, Ahmedabad, 1998.
2. Lord P.R. and Mohammed M.H., "Weaving – Conversion of Yarn to Fabric", Merrow
Publication, 1992.
REFERENCES:
1. John A. Iredale “Yarn Preparation: A Hand Book”, Textile Institute, Manchester, 1992, ISBN:
1853390429
2. Lord P. R. and Mohamed M.H., “Weaving: Conversion of Yarn to Fabric”, Merrow, 1992,
ISBN: 090409538X
3. Ormerod A. and Sondhelm W. S., “Weaving: Technology and Operations”, Textile Institute,
1995, ISBN: 187081276X.
69
Course Articulation Matrix:
Course Statement Program Outcome
Outcomes PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO11 PO12 PSO PSO
PO1 PO2 PSO3
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2
Explain the types of winding,
CO1 yarn faults and automatic 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 3
winding
Elucidate winding package
CO2 faults and winding 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 3
performance
CO3 Discuss the types of warping 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 3
and sizing process
CO4 Describe the process control in 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 3
warping and sizing
CO5 Explain the manual and 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 3
automatic drawing in process
Analyse yarn faults and
CO6 control of faults in cone / 3 3 3 3 2 - - - 2 2 2 1 3 1 2
cheese Winding
Understand the preparatory
CO7 process of fabric 3 3 3 3 2 - - - 2 2 2 1 3 1 2
manufacturing by practice
Overall CO 3 3 3 2.28 2 - - - 2 2 2 1 3 1 2.71
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
70
TT3353 STRUCTURE AND PROPERTIES OF TEXTILE FIBRES LTPC
3 024
OBJECTIVES:
The main objective of this course is to enable the students to understand the
Structure and morphology of textile fibres
Structure investigation techniques
Physical characteristics textile fibres
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Identification of natural, regenerated and synthetic fibres
2. Determination of denier of synthetic fibres
3. Determination of moisture regain and moisture content of fibres
4. Determination of wax content and spin finish of natural and synthetic fibres
5. Identification of fibres and determination of the blend proportion of
a. Cotton/ regenerated cellulose
b. Polyester/ protein fibres
c. Cellulose/polyester fibres
d. Cotton/ viscose/polyester
71
OUTCOME:
Upon completion of this course, the student shall be able to
CO1: Explain the structure and properties of fibres
CO2: Identify the method of investigation of structure of fibres
CO3: Compare and understand moisture absorption behaviour of various fibres
CO4: Demonstrate the tensile and elongation properties of fibres
CO5: Interpret the optical, thermal and frictional characteristics of fibres
CO6: Identify the fibres using, solubility, burning and microscopic test.
CO7: Determine the linear density and moisture properties of fibres
TEXTBOOKS
1. Morton W.E., and Hearle J.W.S.,“Physical Properties of Textile Fibres”, The Textile
Institute, Washington D.C., 2008, ISBN978-1-84569-220-95
2. Hearle J.W.S.,Lomas B.,and CookeW.D., “Atlas of Fibre Fracture and Damage to
Textiles”,The Textile Institute, 2nd Edition, 1998, ISBN:1855733196
REFERENCES
1. Meredith R., and Hearle J. W. S., “Physical Methods of Investigation of Textiles”, Wiley
Publication, New York, 1989, ISBN: B00JCV6ZWU ISBN-13:
2. MukhopadhyayS. K., “Advances in Fibre Science”, The Textile Institute,1992, ISBN:
1870812379
3. MeredithR.,“MechanicalPropertiesofTextileFibres”,NorthHolland,Amsterdam,1986,ISBN:
1114790699, ISBN-13:9781114790698
4. RaheelM. (ed.)., “Modern Textile Characterization Methods”, Marcel Dekker, 1995,
ISBN:0824794737
5. Mukhopadhyay. S. K., “The Structure and Properties of Typical Melt Spun Fibres”, Textile
Progress, Vol. 18, No. 4, Textile Institute, 1989, ISBN:1870812115
6. Hearle J.W.S., “Polymers and Their Properties : Fundamentals of Structures and
Mechanics Vol1”,EllisHorwood,England,1982,ISBN:047027302X|ISBN13:9780470273029
7. Greaves. P. H., and Saville B.P., “Microscopy of Textile Fibres”, Bios Scientific, U.K., 1995,
ISBN: 1872748244 | ISBN-13:9781872748245
8. Seville. B. P., “Physical Testing of Textiles”, Woodhead Publishing, 1999,ISBN:
1855733676 | ISBN-13:9781855733671
9. Hearle J. W. S., and Peters. R. H., “Fibre structure”, Elsevier Ltd, 1963, ISBN: 1483212211
| ISBN-13:9781483212210
72
Course Articulation Matrix:
Course Statement Program Outcome
Outcomes PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO
PO1 PSO3
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2
CO1 Explain the structure and properties of fibres 3 3 2 3 - - 1 - - - - 1 3 1 2
Identify the Method of investigation of structure of
CO2 3 3 2 3 - - 1 - - - - 1 3 1 2
fibres
Compare and understand moisture absorption
CO3 3 3 2 3 - - 1 - - - - 1 3 1 2
behaviour of various fibres
Demonstrate the tensile and elongation properties
CO4 of fibres 3 3 2 3 - - 1 - - - - 1 3 1 2
Interpret the optical, thermal and frictional
CO5 3 3 2 3 - - 1 - - - - 1 3 1 2
characteristics of fibres
Identify the fibres using, solubility, burning and
CO6 3 3 3 3 2 - 1 - 1 2 1 1 3 1 2
microscopic test.
Determine the linear density and moisture
CO7 3 3 3 3 2 - 1 - 1 2 1 1 3 1 2
properties of fibres
Overall CO 3 3 2.28 3 2 - 1 - 1 2 1 1 3 1 2
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
73
TT3352 PRODUCTION OF TEXTILE FIBRES LT PC
3 0 0 3
OBJECTIVES:
To enable the students to learn about the natural fibre production, polymer rheology and the
laws, and various spinning techniques of manufactured fibre production
To expose the students to post spinning and developments in the spinning process
UNIT I NATURAL FIBERS 12
Natural Fibers- production, properties and applications- Evolution of cotton varieties & Cultivation
and harvesting; Bast Fibers: cultivation – Retting – Fibre Extraction; Wool: Types – Rearing –
Shearing – Chemical Composition; Silk: life cycle of silk worm, Types – Reeling – Throwing
UNIT II MELT SPINNING 9
Newtonian and non-newtonian fluids, Melt instabilities; Melt Spinning- Polymer Selection and
Preparation, equipment, properties and applications of polyester, polyamide and polypropylene
fibers.
UNIT III SOLUTION SPINNING 9
Solution spinning- Polymer Selection and Preparation, equipment, properties and applications of
acrylic, polyurethane and regenerated cellulose fibres.
UNIT IV POST SPINNING OPERATIONS 9
Neck drawing, drawing systems, influence of drawing on structure and properties of fibres; Types
of heat setting, influencing parameters on heat setting, influence of heat setting on fibre behavior;
Spin finish composition and application; texturising.
UNIT V DEVELOPMENTS IN FIBER SPINNING 6
Liquid crystal spinning; Gel spinning; Profile fibres and hollow fibres; Speciality fibres: polylactic
acid and chitosan fibres preparation properties and applications.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of this course, the student shall be able to
CO1: Recognize the cultivation and production of natural fibres
CO2: Explain the polymer rheology and polymer process parameters involved in melt spinning.
CO3: Demonstrate the various spinning techniques of polymers parameter involved in spinning
synthetic yarn
CO4: Infer the need of various post spinning operations
CO5: Describe the advances in the spinning process
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Kothari V. K., “Textile Fibres: Development and Innovations”, Vol. 2, Progress in Textiles,
IAFL Publications, New Delhi, 2000
2. Vaidya A. A., “Production of Synthetic Fibres”, Prentice Hall of India Pvt. Ltd., New Delhi,
1988
3. Nakasjima (English edition, edited by Kajiwara K. and McIntyre J. E.), “Advanced Fibre
Spinning Technology”, Wood head Publication Ltd., England, 1994.
REFERENCES:
1. Gupta V. B. and Kothari V. K. (Editors), “Manufactured Fibre Technology”, Kluwer Academic
Publishers, 1997.
2. Cook J. G., “Handbook of Textile Fibres: Vol. 2: Man Made Fibres”, The Textile Inst., 5th Ed.
1984.
3. Srinivasa Murthy H. V., “Introduction to Textile Fibres”, Textile Association, India, 1987.
4. Cook J.G., “Handbook of Textile Fibres: Vol. 1: Natural Fibres” The Textile Inst., 2001
74
Course Articulation Matrix:
Course Statement Program outcome
Outcomes PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO11 PO12 PSO PSO
PO1 PO2 PSO3
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2
CO1 Recognize the cultivation and 3 3 2 2 1 2 2 - - - - 1 3 1 3
production of natural fibres
Explain the polymer rheology
CO2 and polymer process 3 3 2 2 1 2 2 - - - - 1 3 1 3
parameters involved in melt
spinning
Demonstrate the various
spinning techniques of polymers
CO3 3 3 2 2 1 2 2 - - - - 1 3 1 3
parameter involved in spinning
synthetic yarn
Infer the need of various post
CO4 3 3 2 2 1 2 2 - - - - 1 3 1 3
spinning operations
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
75
TT3361 PRE SPINNING LABORATORY L TPC
0 0 3 1.5
OBJECTIVES:
To enable the students to learn passage of materials for ginning, cleaning machines and
carding.
To enable the students to learn passage of materials for drawing and roving machines.
To enable the students to learn bobbin building and process parameters roving bobbins.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS:
1. Construction details of Ginning machine, material passage and ginning out turn calculations
2. Construction details of blowroom machines material passage and production calculations
3. Determine the process parameters of 100% cotton material, running of blowroom machines to
produce lap and running of carding machines to produce sliver
4. Construction details of carding machine, material passage and production calculations
5. Wire point specifications and various settings in a carding machine
6. Construction details of drawing machine, material passage, draft and production calculations
7. Study of construction details of comber preparatory machines, draft, and production calculations
of those machines
8. Study of construction details of comber machines, combing cycle and production calculations
9. Construction details of roving machine, material passage, draft and production calculations
10. Study of bobbin builder mechanism in roving machine.
11. Study of roving frame bobbin stretch variation and to determine the count variation within
bobbin, between bobbin and between front and back row bobbins.
12. Determine process parameters of drawing and roving machines to produce roving bobbins.
13. Handling of accessories – Tachometer, top roller load measuring devices, pressure gauge,
roller eccentricity measuring gauge, leaf gauge, vernier caliber for roller settings, shore
hardness tester etc.,
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
OUTCOMES:
Upon the completion of this course the student will be able to
CO1: Discuss the ginning, cleaning machine’s material passage and carryout production
calculations.
CO2: Explain the carding, drawing and roving machine’s material passage and carryout production
calculations.
CO3: Understand the process parameters in the blowroom, carding machine drawing and simplex
machines
76
Course Articulation Matrix:
Program Outcome
Course
Statement PO PO
Outcomes PO3 PO4 PO5 PO6 PO7 PO8 PO9 PO10 PO11 PO12 PSO1 PSO2 PSO3
1 2
Discuss the
ginning, cleaning
machine’s
CO1. material passage 3 3 3 3 2 - 1 - 2 2 2 1 3 1 2
and carryout
production
calculations.
Explain the
carding, drawing
and roving
machine’s
CO2. material passage 3 3 3 3 2 - 1 - 2 2 2 1 3 1 2
and carryout
production
calculations.
Understand the
process
parameters in the
CO3. blow room, 3 3 3 3 2 - 1 - 2 2 2 1 3 1 2
carding machine
draw frame and
roving machines
Overall
3 3 3 3 2 - 1 - 2 2 2 1 3 1 2
CO
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
77
GE3361 PROFESSIONAL DEVELOPMENT LTPC
0 021
OBJECTIVES:
To be proficient in important Microsoft Office tools: MS WORD, EXCEL, POWERPOINT.
To be proficient in using MS WORD to create quality technical documents, by using
standard templates, widely acceptable styles and formats, variety of features to enhance
the presentability and overall utility value of content.
To be proficient in using MS EXCEL for all data manipulation tasks including the common
statistical, logical, mathematical etc., operations, conversion, analytics, search and explore,
visualize,interlink, and utilizing many more critical features offered
To be able to create and share quality presentations by using the features of MS
PowerPoint, including: organization of content, presentability, aesthetics, using media
elements and enhance the overall quality of presentations.
MS WORD: 10 Hours
Create and format a document
Working with tables
Working with Bullets and Lists
Working with styles, shapes, smart art, charts
Inserting objects, charts and importing objects from other office tools
Creating and Using document templates
Inserting equations, symbols and special characters
Working with Table of contents and References, citations
Insert and review comments
Create bookmarks, hyperlinks, endnotes footnote
Viewing document in different modes
Working with document protection and security
Inspect document for accessibility
MS EXCEL: 10 Hours
Create worksheets, insert and format data
Work with different types of data: text, currency, date, numeric etc.
Split, validate, consolidate, Convert data
Sort and filter data
Perform calculations and use functions: (Statistical, Logical, Mathematical, date, Time etc.,)
Work with Lookup and reference formulae
Create and Work with different types of charts
Use pivot tables to summarize and analyse data
Perform data analysis using own formulae and functions
Combine data from multiple worksheets using own formulae and built-in functions to generate
results
Export data and sheets to other file formats
Working with macros
Protecting data and Securing the workbook
MS POWERPOINT: 10 Hours
Select slide templates, layout and themes
Formatting slide content and using bullets and numbering
Insert and format images, smart art, tables, charts
Using Slide master, notes and handout master
Working with animation and transitions
Organize and Group slides
Import or create and use media objects: audio, video, animation
78
Perform slideshow recording and Record narration and create presentable videos
TOTAL: 30 PERIODS
OUTCOMES:
On successful completion the students will be able to
Use MS Word to create quality documents, by structuring and organizing content
for their day to day technical and academic requirements
Use MS EXCEL to perform data operations and analytics, record, retrieve data as
per requirements and visualize data for ease of understanding
Use MS PowerPoint to create high quality academic presentations by including
common tables, charts, graphs, interlinking other elements, and using media
objects.
79
2. Study of bobbin builder mechanism in ring spinning machine
3. Study of ring spinning machine and to calculate draft and twist. To determine yarn twist variation
when the yarn wind at minimum and maximum diameters of bobbin
3. Construction details of rotor spinning machine, material passage, draft and production
calculations.
4. Production of yarn in ring spinning machine
5. Production of yarn in rotor spinning machine
6. Study and analysis of MIS report of spinning Mill.
7. Study and analysis of spectrogram, V-L curve, and evenness test results.
OUTCOMES:
Upon the completion of this course, the student will be able to
CO1: Discuss the yarn formation, draft, twist and production calculation in ring spinning.
CO2: Explain the principle, properties and different methods of condensed yarn spinning.
CO3: Describe the yarn plying and production methods of fancy yarn.
CO4: Explain the principle, properties and different methods of rotor spinning.
CO5: Explain the friction, air jet, vortex, self twist, core and wrap yarn production methods.
CO6: Describe the material passage and carryout twist, draft and production calculation of ring
and rotor spinning machines.
CO7: Determine the process parameters of ring and rotor spinning machines.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Klein W., Vol. 1-3, “The Technology of Short Staple Spinning”, “A Practical Guide to Opening
& Carding” and “A Practical Guide to Combing, Drawing, and Roving frame”, The Textile
Institute, Manchester, U.K., 1998.
2. Chattopadhyay R. (Ed), Advances in Technology of Yarn Production, NCUTE, IIT Delhi,
2002.
3. Klein W., Vol.4 - 5, “A Practical Guide to Ring Spinning", 1987, and “New Spinning
Systems", 1993, The Textile Institute, Manchester, 1987.
4. Gowda R.V.M, “New Spinning Systems”, NCUTE, IIT Delhi, 2003.
REFERENCES:
1. Oxtoby E., “Spun Yarn Technology “, Butterworth Publications, London, 1987
2. Lord P.R., “Yarn Production: Science, Technology and Economics”, The Textile Institute,
Manchester, 1999
3. Shaw J., “Short-staple Ring Spinning, Textile Progress”, The Textile Institute, Manchester,
982
4. Iredale J., “Yarn Preparation: A Handbook “, Intermediate Technology, 1992.
80
Course Articulation Matrix:
Course Statement Program
Outcomes Outcome
PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO
PO1 PSO3
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2
Discuss the yarn formation, draft,
CO1 twist and production calculation in 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 1
ring spinning.
Explain the principle, properties
CO2 and different methods of 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 1
condensed yarn spinning.
Describe the yarn plying and
CO3 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 1
production methods of fancy yarn.
Explain the principle, properties
CO4 and different methods of rotor 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 1
spinning.
Explain the , friction, air jet, vortex,
CO5 self twist, core and wrap yarn 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 1
production methods
Describe the material passage and
carryout twist, draft and production
CO6 calculation of ring and rotor spinning 3 3 3 3 2 - 1 - 2 2 2 1 3 1 2
machines
Determine the process
CO7 parameters of ring and rotor 3 3 3 3 2 - 1 - 2 2 2 1 3 1 2
spinning machines.
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
81
TT3453 TECHNOLOGY OF WOVEN FABRIC MANUFACTURE LTPC
3003
OBJECTIVE:
To enable the students to understand various functions of the preparation for weaving
machine and process control.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Talukdar, M.K., “An Introduction to Winding and Warping”, Textile Trade Press, Mumbai.
2. Talukdar M.K., Sriramulu P.K. and Ajgaonkar D.B., “Weaving: Machines, Mechanisms,
Management”, Mahajan Publishers, Ahmedabad, 1998, ISBN: 81-85401-16-0
3. Marks R. and Robinson T.C., “Principles of Weaving”, The Textile Institute, Manchester,
1989, ISBN: 0 900739 258
82
REFERENCES:
1. Ajgaonkar, D.B., “Sizing, Materials, Methods and Machines”, Textile Trade Press, Mumbai,
1982.
2. “Weaving: The knowledge in Technology”, Papers Presented at the Textile Institute Weaving
Conference 1998, Textile Institute, ISBN: 18770372182
3. Booth J.E., “Textile Mathematics Volume 3”, The Textile Institute, Manchester, 1977, ISBN:
090073924X
4. Lord P.R. and Mohamed M.H., “Weaving: Conversion of Yarn to Fabric”, Merrow, 1992,
ISBN: 090409538X
5. Ormerod A. and Sondhelm W.S., “Weaving: Technology and operations”, Textile Institute,
1995, ISBN: 187081276X
6. Sabit Adanur, “Handbook of Weaving”, Technomic Publishing Co. Inc., 2001
83
Course Articulation Matrix:
Course Statement Program
Outcomes Outcome
PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO11 PO12 PSO PSO
PO1 PO2 PSO3
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2
CO1 Explain the primary, secondary 3 3 3 2 2 - - 1 3 1 2
- - - -
and auxiliary motions of loom
CO2 Discuss the types of shedding 3 3 3 2 2 - - 1 3 1 2
- - - -
mechanism
Explain the types of weft
CO3 insertion and beat up 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
mechanism
Describe the let – off, take – up
CO4 and shuttle changing 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
mechanism
Discuss the process control in
CO5 weaving and special weaving 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
processes
Overall CO 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
84
TT3452 KNITTING TECHNOLOGY LTPC
3003
OBJECTIVES:
To make the students to understand fundamentals of knitting, types of knitting processes in
detail, the functioning of components of knitting machine and knitted fabric structures.
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 5
Reasons for the growth of the knitting industry; comparison of fabric properties - woven, knits and
bonded fabrics; classification of knitting processes – weft knit & warp knit; yarn quality
requirements for knitting; preparation of staple yarns for weft and warp knitting
REFERENCES
1. Ajgaonkar D.B., “Knitting Technology”, Universal Publishing Corporation, Mumbai, 1998,
ISBN: 81-85027-34-X.
85
2. Samuel Raz., “Flat Knitting: The new generation”, Meisenbach GmbH, Bamberg, 1997,
ISBN: 3-87525-054-0.
3. Samuel Raz., “Warp Knitting production”, MelliandTextilberichte, GmbH, Rohrbacher, 1987,
ISBN: 3-87529-022.
4. Baneerjee.P.K., “Principles of Fabric Formation”, CRC Press, London, 2014, ISBN
Number:13:978-1-4665-5445-0
5. Ray.S.C., “Fundamentals and advances in Knitting Technology”, Woodhead Publishing India
Pvt., Ltd, New Delhi. 2011, ISBN: 978-93-80308-16-6.
6. Abhijit Majumdar, Apurba Das, R.Alagirusamy and V.K.Kothari., “Process Control in Textile
Manufacturing”, Wood Head Publishing Limited, Oxford, 2013, ISBN: 978-0-85709-027-0.
7. Gajjap B.J., “Handbook of warp Knitting Technology”, Textile Institute, Manchester, 2004,
ISBN: 1 85573 7701.
86
Course Articulation Matrix:
Course Statement Program
Outcomes Outcome
PO1 PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO PSO3
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2
Classify the knitting process and
CO1 understand the yarn requirements for 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
knitting process
Explain the types of knitting needle
CO2 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
and elements of knitting
CO3 Discuss the weft knit structures 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
Explain the working of weft
CO4 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
knitting machines and its types
Discuss the principle, elements and
CO5 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
types of warp knitting machine
Overall CO 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
87
TT3451 CHEMICAL PROCESSING OF TEXTILE MATERIALS I LTPC
3003
OBJECTIVE:
To enable the students to learn about pre-treatments processes and the machineries
involved in the wet processing and dyeing of textiles fabrics.
UNIT I PREPARATORY PROCESS 9
Pretreatments-process Sequence; singeing and desizing of natural and synthetic fibres and its
blends; heat setting; Scouring, bleaching and mercerization of cotton, bio-scouring of cotton;
carbonization, scouring and bleaching of wool; degumming and bleaching of silk
UNIT IV DYEING 9
Technology of application of direct, reactive, vat, disperse, acid and basic dyes.
88
REFERENCES
1. Choudhury A. K. R., “Textile Preparation and Dyeing”, SDC India Region,2011.
2. Bhagwat R. S., “Handbook of Textile Processing”, Colour Publication, Mumbai. 1999.
3. Cavaco-Paulo A. and Gubitz G. M., “Textile Processing with enzymes”, Woodhead
Publication Ltd., 2003.
4. Chakraborty J.N., "Fundamentals and practice in Colouration of Textiles", Wood head
Publishing India Pvt Ltd, India, 2010, ISBN: 184569788X | ISBN-13: 9781845697884.
5. Mittal R.M., and Trivedi S.S., “Chemical Processing of Polyester/Cellulosic Blends”, 2nd ed.,
Tata McGraw Hill, 2000.
6. Burkinshaw S. M., “Chemical Principles of Synthetic Fibre Dyeing", Springer-Science +
Business Media, B.V., 2012, ISBN: 9401042632 | ISBN-13: 9789401042635.
89
Course Articulation Matrix:
Course Statement Program
Outcomes Outcome
PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO
PO1 PSO3
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2
Demonstrate the scouring and
CO1 bleaching of textile fabrics 3 2 2 2 2 - 2 - - - - 1 3 1 2
Describe the functions of
CO2 chemical processing machineries 3 2 2 2 2 - 2 - - - - 1 3 1 2
Explain the theory,
CO3 classification and application 3 2 2 2 2 - 2 - - - - 1 3 1 2
of dyes
Explain application of dye for
CO4 3 2 2 2 2 - 2 - - - - 1 3 1 2
various fibres
Explain the theory and
CO5 measurement of color 3 2 2 2 2 - 2 - - - - 1 3 1 2
Overall CO 3 2 2 2 2 - 2 - - - - 1 3 1 2
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
90
TT3401 WOVEN FABRIC STRUCTURE AND DESIGN LTPC
3003
OBJECTIVES:
To enable the students to learn about different structures of woven fabric and design the
structure for differentapplications
UNIT I 9
Introduction – methods of representing weave in point paper, construction of design, draft and
lifting plan, types of draft, heald calculation, order of denting; elementary weaves – plain, twill,
satin, sateen and their derivatives – loom requirements
UNIT II 9
Ordinary and brighten honey comb; huck-a-back and its modifications; mock Leno; crepe
weaves; colour theory– light and pigment theory; modification of colour; colour and weave
effects; loom requirements
UNIT III 9
Bedford cords - plain and twill faced, wadded; welts and piques, wadded piques; backed fabrics
warp and weft, reversible and non-reversible fabrics; extra warp and extra weft figuring - single
and double colour – loom requirements
UNIT IV 9
Pile fabrics; warp pile - wire pile, terry pile, loose backed; weft pile – plain back and twill back
velveteen, lashedpile, corduroy, and weft plush – loom requirements
UNIT V 9
Double cloth, types of stitches; Damasks; Gauze and Leno principles – loom requirements; trade
name of popular structures
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
OUTCOMES:
Upon the completion of this course the student will be able to construct design, draft and peg
plan and loomrequirements for producing
CO1: Fabrics with plain, twill, satin and derivatives structures
CO2: Fabrics with honey comb, crepe structures
CO3: Bedford cords, piques, backed fabrics, extra warp/weft figuring fabrics
CO4: Fabrics with warp and weft pile structures
CO5: Fabrics with double, damask, gauze and leno structures
TEXTBOOKS
1. Grosicki Z. J., “Watson’s Textile Design and Colour”, Vol.1, Wood head Publications,
Cambridge England,2004, ISBN: 1 85573 7701 24.
2. Grosicki Z. J., “Watson’s Advanced Textile Design and Colour”, Vol. II, Butterworths,
London, 1989,ISBN-9781855739963
REFERENCES
1. Wilson J., “Handbook of Textile Design”, Textile Institute, Manchester, 2001, ISBN: 1 85573
5733.
2. Horne C.E., “Geometric Symmetry in Patterns and Tilings”, Textile Institute, Manchester,
2000, ISBN: 185573 4923.
3. Seyam A. M., “Structural Design of Woven Fabrics, Theory and Practice”, Textile Institute,
Manchester, 2002, ISBN: 1 87037 2395.
4. GeornerD., “Woven Structure and Design, part 1: Single Cloth Construction”, WIRA, U.K.,
1986, ISBN: 0900820179 | ISBN-13: 9780900820175
5. GeornerD., “Woven Structure and Design, Part 2: Compound Structures”, WIRA, U.K.,
1989, ISBN:090366951X | ISBN-13: 9780903669511
6. Jan Shenton., “Woven Textile Design”, Laurence King Publishing, 2014, ISBN:
178067337X ISBN-13: 9781780673370.
91
Course Articulation Matrix:
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
92
GE3451 ENVIRONMENTAL SCIENCES AND SUSTAINABILITY L T P C
2 0 0 2
OBJECTIVES:
To introduce the basic concepts of environment, ecosystems and biodiversity and
emphasize on the biodiversity of India and its conservation.
To impart knowledge on the causes, effects and control or prevention measures of
environmental pollution and natural disasters.
To facilitate the understanding of global and Indian scenario of renewable and
nonrenewable resources, causes of their degradation and measures to preserve them.
To familiarize the concept of sustainable development goals and appreciate the
interdependence of economic and social aspects of sustainability, recognize and analyze
climate changes, concept of carbon credit and the challenges of environmental
management.
To inculcate and embrace sustainability practices and develop a broader understanding on
green materials, energy cycles and analyze the role of sustainable urbanization.
93
To identify and apply the understanding of renewable and non-renewable resources and
contribute to the sustainable measures to preserve them for future generations.
To recognize the different goals of sustainable development and apply them for suitable
technological advancement and societal development.
To demonstrate the knowledge of sustainability practices and identify green materials,
energy cycles and the role of sustainable urbanization.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Anubha Kaushik and C. P. Kaushik’s “Perspectives in Environmental Studies”, 6th Edition,
New Age International Publishers ,2018.
2. Benny Joseph, ‘Environmental Science and Engineering’, Tata McGraw-Hill, New Delhi,
2016.
3. Gilbert M.Masters, ‘Introduction to Environmental Engineering and Science’, 2nd edition,
Pearson Education, 2004.
4. Allen, D. T. and Shonnard, D. R., Sustainability Engineering: Concepts, Design and Case
Studies, Prentice Hall.
5. Bradley. A.S; Adebayo, A.O., Maria, P. Engineering applications in sustainable design and
development, Cengage learning.
6. Environment Impact Assessment Guidelines, Notification of Government of India, 2006.
7. Mackenthun, K.M., Basic Concepts in Environmental Management, Lewis Publication,
London, 1998.
REFERENCE BOOKS:
1. R.K. Trivedi, ‘Handbook of Environmental Laws, Rules, Guidelines, Compliances and
Standards’, Vol. I and II, Enviro Media. 38 .
2. Cunningham, W.P. Cooper, T.H. Gorhani, ‘Environmental Encyclopedia’, Jaico Publ.,
House, Mumbai, 2001.
3. Dharmendra S. Sengar, ‘Environmental law’, Prentice hall of India PVT. LTD, New Delhi,
2007.
4. Rajagopalan, R, ‘Environmental Studies-From Crisis to Cure’, Oxford University Press,
2005.
5. Erach Bharucha “Textbook of Environmental Studies for Undergraduate Courses” Orient
Blackswan Pvt. Ltd. 2013.
94
NCC Credit Course Level 2*
NX3451 (ARMY WING) NCC Credit Course Level - II LT P C
3 0 0 3
PERSONALITY DEVELOPMENT 9
PD 3 Group Discussion: Change your mindset, Time Management, Social Skills 6
PD 5 Public Speaking 3
LEADERSHIP 7
L2 Case Studies: APJ Abdul Kalam, Deepa Malik, Maharana Pratap, N Narayan Murty,
Ratan Tata, Rabindra Nath Tagore, Role of NCC cadets in 1965 7
DISASTER MANAGEMENT 13
DM 1 Disaster Management Capsule: Organisation, Types of Disasters, Essential Services,
Assistance, Civil Defence Organisation 3
DM 2 Initiative Training, Organising Skills, Do's & Don’t's,
Natural Disasters, Man Made Disasters 9
DM 3 Fire Service & Fire Fighting 1
GENERAL AWARENESS 4
GA 1 General Knowledge 4
ARMED FORCES 6
AF 1 Armed Forces, Army, CAPF, Police 6
ADVENTURE 1
AD 1 Introduction to Adventure Activities 1
BORDER & COASTAL AREAS 2
BCA 1 History, Geography & Topography of Border/Coastal areas 2
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
LEADERSHIP 7
L2 Case Studies: APJ Abdul Kalam, Deepa Malik, Maharana Pratap, N Narayan Murty,
Ratan Tata, Rabindra Nath Tagore, Role of NCC cadets in 1965 7
DISASTER MANAGEMENT 13
DM 1 Disaster Management Capsule: Organisation, Types of Disasters, Essential Services,
Assistance, Civil Defence Organisation 3
95
DM 2 Initiative Training, Organising Skills, Do's & Don’t's,
Natural Disasters, Man Made Disasters 9
DM 3 Fire Service & Fire Fighting 1
GENERAL AWARENESS 4
GA 1 General Knowledge 4
NAVAL ORIENTATION 6
AF 1 Armed Forces and Navy Capsule 3
EEZ 1 EEZ Maritime Security and ICG 3
ADVENTURE 1
AD 1 Introduction to Adventure Activities 1
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
PERSONALITY DEVELOPMENT 9
PD 3 Group Discussion: Change your mindset, Time Management, Social Skills 6
PD 5 Public Speaking 3
LEADERSHIP 7
L2 Case Studies: APJ Abdul Kalam, Deepa Malik, Maharana Pratap, N Narayan Murty,
Ratan Tata, Rabindra Nath Tagore, Role of NCC cadets in 1965 7
DISASTER MANAGEMENT 13
DM 1 Disaster Management Capsule: Organisation, Types of Disasters, Essential Services,
Assistance, Civil Defence Organisation 3
DM 2 Initiative Training, Organising Skills, Do's & Don’t's,
Natural Disasters, Man Made Disasters 9
DM 3 Fire Service & Fire Fighting 1
GENERAL AWARENESS 4
GA 1 General Knowledge 4
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Determination of depth of shed and heald shaft movements in tappet shedding mechanism
2. Preparation of pattern card for dobby shedding mechanism and way in which adjust the depth of
shed
3. Study of dobby shedding mechanism
4. Study of jacquard shedding mechanism
5. Study of picking mechanisms in looms
6. Determination of sley eccentricity in shuttle loom
7. Study of let-off mechanisms
8. Determination of pick space through 5 and 7 wheel take-up mechanisms
9. Study of weft replenishment mechanism in shuttle looms
10. Method of achieving the required colour patterns in 4 X 1 drop box motion
11. Study of warp stop, weft stop and warp protector mechanisms
12. Understanding of the loom requirements from the given sample
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of this course, the students would have practical knowledge on
CO1: Shedding and picking mechanism
CO2: Beat up Let- off take – up mechanisms and warp and weft stop motions
CO3: Colour patterning in weaving machine
97
Course Articulation Matrix:
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
98
TT3462 FABRIC STRUCTURE ANALYSIS LABORATORY L TPC
0 0 3 1.5
OBJECTIVES:
To enable the students to analyse different fabrics for structure and constructional details
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
Analysis of weave and construction details (Design, Draft, lifting plan, thread density, warp,
weft count, crimp, GSM) of fabrics with
1. Plain weave
2. Rib/mat weaves
3. Twill/wavy twill weaves
4. Herringbone/diamond/diaper
5. Sateen and satin weaves
6. Crepe weaves
7. Honeycomb, huck-a-back and mock-leno weaves
8. Double cloth
9. Terry weaves
10. Bedford cord weaves
11. Determination of weave plan for manufacturing 100 meter of different woven fabrics
12. Analysis of structure and construction details of single jersey and double jersey knit fabrics
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
OUTCOMES:
Upon the completion of this course the student will be able to
CO1: Draw the structure of woven fabrics with different weaves and structure of knitted fabrics.
CO2 Extract the weave from the given sample and draw the weave, draft and peg- plan for re-
production.
CO3: Develop the weave plan for production of woven fabrics
99
Course Articulation Matrix:
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
100
TT3511 INDUSTRIAL TRAINING / INTERNSHIP I* LTPC
000 2
OBJECTIVES:
To enable the students to
Get connected with industry/ laboratory/research institute
Get practical knowledge on production process in the industry and develop skills to solve
related problems
Develop skills to carry out research in the research institutes/laboratories
The students individually undergo training in reputed firms/ research institutes / laboratories for the
specified duration. After the completion of training, a detailed report should be submitted within ten
days from the commencement of next semester. The students will be evaluated as per the
Regulations.
No.of. Weeks: 04
OUTCOMES:
On completion of the course, the student will know about
CO1: Plant layout, machinery, organizational structure and production processes in the firm or
research facilities in the laboratory/research institute
CO2: Analysis of industrial / research problems and their solutions
CO3: Documenting of material specifications, machine and process parameters, testing
parameters and results
CO4: Preparing of Technical report and presentation
TEXTBOOKS
1. Booth J.E., “Principle of Textile Testing”, Butterworth Publications, London, 1989, ISBN:
0592063259 | ISBN-13: 9780592063256.
2. Kothari V. K., “Progress in Textiles: Science & Technology Vol 1 Testing & Quality
Management”, IAFL Publications, New Delhi, 1999, ISBN: 819010330X | ISBN-13:
9788190103305
REFERENCS
1. Seville B.P., “Physical Testing of Textiles”, Textile Institute, Manchester, 1999, ISBN:
1855733676 | ISBN-13: 9781855733671.
2. Ruth E.Glock., and Grace I. Kunz., “Apparel Manufacturing – Sewn Product Analysis
FourthEdition”, Pearson/Prentice Hall, 2005, ISBN: 0131119826 / ISBN: 978-0131119826
3. Pradip V. Mehta P.E., and Satish K. Bhardwaj., “Managing Quality in the Apparel Industry”,
National Institute of Fashion Technology, India 1998, ISBN: 8122411665 | ISBN-13:
9788122411669
4. Sara J. Kadolph., “Quality Assurance for Textiles and Apparels”, Fair child Publications,
New York, 2007, ISBN: 1563675544 | ISBN-13: 9781563675546.
5. Slater K., “Physical Testing and Quality Control”, The Textile Institute, Vol.23, No.1/2/3
Manchester, 1993, ISBN: 187081245X | ISBN-13: 9781870812450.
102
Course Articulation Matrix:
Course Statement Program
Outcomes Outcome
PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO
PO1 PSO3
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2
Explain the importance and test
CO1 procedure for various fibres and its 3 3 2 3 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
properties
Discuss the testing of various yarn
CO2 properties 3 3 2 3 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
Describe various test procedure for
CO3 fabric mechanical and aesthetic 3 3 2 3 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
related properties
Explain the test procedure for
CO4 determining low stress mechanical 3 3 2 3 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
properties of fabric
Discuss the fabric inspection and
CO5 quality assessments of garment 3 3 2 3 2 - - 2 - - - 1 3 1 2
Overall CO 3 3 2 3 2 - - 2 - - - 1 3 1 2
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
103
TT3581 TESTING OF TEXTILE MATERIALS LABORATORY LTPC
0 0 3 1.5
OBJECTIVE:
To make the students practically learn various fibre, yarn and fabric evaluation procedures
to determine characteristics of fibres, yarn and fabric
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
Determination of
1. Fibre fineness, length and maturity
2. Fibre trash content, Bundle fibre strength
3. Sliver/roving/ yarn linear density
4. Single yarn strength and Yarn Lea strength
5. Yarn single and ply yarn twist
6. Unevenness of yarn and assessment of yarn appearance
7. Fabric tensile strength,
8. Fabric tear and bursting strength
9. Fabric flexural rigidity, bending modulus and crease recovery
10. Drapeability skew and bowness of fabric
11. Fabric abrasion and pilling resistance
12. Fabric air permeability
13. Fabric weight, thickness and dimensional stability
14. Seam strength and seam slippage
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
OUTCOMES:
Upon the completion of this course the student will be able to
CO 1: Measure important characteristics of fibre and yarn
CO2: Determine the important characteristics of fabrics
CO3: Measure the seam strength and slippage of garment
104
Course Articulation Matrix:
Program
Course Outcome
Statement
Outcomes PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO
PO1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2 PSO3
CO1 Measure important 3 2 - - - 2 2 2 1 3 2 3
characteristics of fibre and yarn 3 3 3
CO2 Determine the important 3 2 - - - 2 2 2 1 3 2 3
characteristics of fabrics 3 3 3
Measure the seam strength and 3 2 - - - 2 2 2 1 3 2 3
CO3 slippage of garment 3 3 3
Overall CO 3 3 3 3 2 - - - 2 2 2 1 3 2 3
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
105
TT3651 CHEMICAL PROCESSING OF TEXTILE MATERIALS II LTPC
3003
OBJECTIVE:
To enable the students to understand the color science, finishing, theory of dyeing and
printing of woven fabrics, knitted fabrics and garments
REFERENCES
1. Schindler W.D and Hauser P., “Chemical Finishing of Textiles”., Wood head Publications,
ISBN: 1855739054
2. Yin-Ling Lam , Chi-Wai Kan & Chun-Wah Marcus Yuen, " Developments in functional
finishing of cotton fibres – wrinkle-resistant, flame retardant and antimicrobial treatments",
Textile Progress, Vol. 44, Nos. 3-4, Septembr-December 2012, 175–249
106
3. Shenai V. A., “Technology of Printing”, Sevak Publications, Mumbai, 1996.
4. Miles W. C., “Textile Printing”, Wood head Publication, 2003, ISBN 0 901956 76 1.
5. Jones B. W., “Garment Dyeing: Ready to Wear Fashion from the Dyehouse”, Textile
Progress, Vol. 19, No. 2, 1988, ISBN 1870812131.
6. Roshan Paul (Ed.)., “Denim – Manufacture Finishing and Applications”, Wood head
Publishing, 2015, ISBN: 0857098438 | ISBN-13: 9780857098436
107
Course Articulation Matrix:
Course Statement Program
Outcomes Outcome
PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO
PO1 PSO3
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2
Understand various methods of
CO1 printing for different textile fibre 3 2 2 2 2 - 3 - - - - 1 3 1 2
material
Distinguish various styles of
CO2 printing 3 2 2 2 2 - 3 - - - - 1 3 1 2
Classify various finishing of
CO3 textile fabrics with detailed 3 2 2 2 2 - 3 - - - - 1 3 1 2
application techniques
Apply various functional finishes
CO4 3 2 2 2 2 - 3 - - - - 1 3 1 2
to the textile fabrics
Review the effluents of textiles and
CO5 their treatments 3 2 2 2 2 - 3 - - - - 1 3 1 2
Overall CO 3 2 2 2 2 - 3 - - - - 1 3 1 2
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
108
TT3691 TECHNOLOGY OF NONWOVEN LTPC
3003
OBJECTIVES:
To enable the students to learn about the fundamentals of bonded fabrics and different
method of web formation and bonding
TEXTBOOKS
1. Lunenschloss J., Albrecht W. and David Sharp., “Nonwoven Bonded Fabrics”, Ellis
HorwoodLtd., New York, 1985, ISBN: 0-85312-636-4.
2. Mrstina V. and Feigl F., “Needle Punching Textile Technology”, Elsevier, New York, 1990,ISBN:
0444988041 | ISBN-13: 9780444988041
REFERENCES
1. Dharmadhikary R. K., Gilmore T. F., Davis H. A. and Batra S. K., “Thermal Bonding of
Nonwoven Fabrics”, Textile Progress, Vol.26, No.2, Textile Institute Manchester, 1995,
ISBN:1870812786.
2. Jirsak O. and Wadsworth L. C., “Nonwoven Textiles”, Textile Institute, Manchester, 1999, ISBN:
0 89089 9788.
3. Russell S., “Hand Book of Nonwovens”, Textile Institute, Manchester, 2004, ISBN:1855736039.
4. Chapman R., “Applications of Nonwovens in Technical Textiles”, Textile Institute, Manchester,
2010, ISBN: 1 84569 4376
109
5. Abhijit Majumdar, Apurba Das, R.Alagirusamy and V.K.Kothari., “Process Control in Textile
Manufacturing”, Wood Head Publishing Limited, Oxford, 2013, ISBN: 978-0-85709-027-0.
110
Course Articulation Matrix:
Program
Course Outcome
Statement
Outcomes PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO
PO1 PSO3
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2
Explain the basics of nonwoven
CO1 3 2 2 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
web formation techniques
Discuss the mechanical bonding
CO2 3 2 2 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
technique to produce nonwovens
Explain the chemical and thermal
CO3 bonding methods to produce 3 2 2 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
nonwovens and their end uses
Discuss the production of spun
CO4 bonded and melt blown 3 2 2 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
nonwoven fabrics
Explain the finishing and
CO5 characterization of bonded 3 2 2 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
fabrics
Overall CO 3 2 2 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
111
TT3601 MECHANICS OF TEXTILE MACHINERY L T PC
3 0 03
OBJECTIVES:
To enable the students to learn about Mechanics of elements of textile machinery, design
of cams, cone drums and other important elements used in the textile machinery
UNIT IV FRICTION 9
Friction-static, dynamic; laws of friction; clutches and brakes – types, features, application in textile
machines; bearings types, features, application in textile machinery
UNIT V DESIGN 9
Design of drive transmitting shafts, Design of drums used in winders; Design of tappets and cams;
unbalance, balancing of rotating masses
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of the course students will
CO1: Have knowledge of types of power transmission systems, gears, gear trains and their
applications CO2: Be able to explain linear and circular motion, force,energy and power.
CO3: be able to understand and design variable speed drive systems
CO4: Have knowledge on friction and explain the function of clutches and brakes and different
types of bearings
CO5: Be able to design drums, tappets and cams used in textile machinery
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Booth J. E., “Textile Mathematics”, Vol. 2&3, The Textile Institute, Manchester, 1975.
2. Slater K., “Textile Mechanics”, Vol. 1&2, The Textile Institute, Manchester, 1977.
REFERENCES:
1. Rengasamy R. S., “Mechanics of Spinning Machines”, NCUTE, Ministry of Textiles, Govt.
of India, 2000.
2. https://nptel.ac.in/courses/116102012
112
Course Articulation Matrix:
Program
Course Outcome
Statement
Outcomes PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO
PO1 PSO3
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2
Have knowledge of types of power
CO1 transmission systems, gears, gear 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
trains and their applications
Able to explain linear and circular
CO2 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
motion, force,energy and power
understand and design variable
CO3 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
speed drive systems
Have knowledge on friction and
explain the function of clutches and
CO4 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
brakes and different types of
bearings
Be able to design drums, tappets
CO5 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
and cams used in textile machinery
Overall CO 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
113
NCC Credit Course Level 3*
NX3651 (ARMY WING) NCC Credit Course - III LT P C
3 00 3
PERSONALITY DEVELOPMENT 9
PD 3 Group Discussion: Team Work 2
PD 4 Career Counselling, SSB Procedure & Interview Skills 3
PD 5 Public Speaking 4
BORDER & COASTAL AREAS 4
BCA 2 Security Setup and Border/Coastal management in the area 2
BCA 3 Security Challenges & Role of cadets in Border management 2
ARMED FORCES 3
AF 2 Modes of Entry to Army, CAPF, Police 3
COMMUNICATION 3
C1 Introduction to Communication & Latest Trends 3
INFANTRY 3
INF 1 Organisation of Infantry Battalion & its weapons 3
MILITARY HISTORY 23
MH 1 Biographies of Renowned Generals 4
MH 2 War Heroes - PVC Awardees 4
MH 3 Study of Battles - Indo Pak War 1965, 1971 & Kargil 9
MH 4 War Movies 6
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
115
TT3661 TEXTILE CHEMICAL PROCESSING LABORATORY LTPC
0 0 3 1.5
OBJECTIVE:
To enable the students to gain knowledge in quantitative analysis, pre-
treatment, dyeing and printing of textile materials.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS:
1. Desizing of cotton fabrics
2. Scouring of cotton yarn / fabric
3. Peroxide bleaching of cotton yarn /fabric
4. Dyeing of cotton yarn using reactive dyes (cold / hot brands)
5. Dyeing of cotton yarn using Vat dyes
6. Degumming and bleaching of silk yarn
7. Dyeing of silk yarn with acid dyes / Reactive dyes
8. Dyeing of polyester yarn using Disperse dye
9. Printing of cotton fabrics with Pigments by Direct style using Blocks / screens
10. Printing of polyester fabrics with Disperse dyes by Direct style using Blocks / Screens
11. Determination of wash and rubbing fastness of dyed yarn/fabrics
12. Printing of cotton fabric by resist style (Batik printing , tie and dye) using Reactive cold
brand / cold dyeing Vat dyes
13. Determination of whiteness and yellowness index using computer color matching
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
OUTCOME:
Upon the completion of this course the student will be able to,
CO1: Desize, scour and bleach cotton yarn / fabric
CO2: Dye different yarns / fabrics with different types of colorants and determine the
different fastness
CO 3: Print different fabrics with different types of colorants by different styles
116
Course Articulation Matrx:
Program
Course Outcome
Statement
Outcomes PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO
PO1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2 PSO3
Desize, scour and bleach
CO1 3 3 3 3 - 1 1 - 2 1 1 1 3 1 1
cotton yarn / fabric
Dye different yarns / fabrics
with different types of
CO2 colorants and determine 3 3 3 3 - 1 1 - 2 1 1 1 3 1 3
the different
fastness
Print different fabrics with
CO3 different types of colorants by 3 3 3 3 - 1 1 - 2 1 1 1 3 1 3
different styles
Overall CO 3 3 3 3 - 1 1 - 2 1 1 1 3 1 2.33
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
117
TT3611 TEXTILE PRODUCT ENGINEERING LABORATORY L T P C
0 0 3 1.5
OBJECTIVES:
To enable the students to test and analyse the given product that include identification of
fibre, yarn, sourcing of raw materials and accessories, fabric specifications, method of
production of same and costing
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
Reverse engineering of textile products with an emphasis on testing protocols – Two each for a
student
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
OUTCOMES:
Upon the completion of this course the student will be able to
CO1: Identify the materials used in the product
CO2: Carryout confirmative tests to identify specifications of materials used
CO3: Suggest the production process required to make the product
CO4: Costing of product
118
Course Articulation Matrix
Program Outcome
Course
Statement PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PSO
Outcomes PO1 PO2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 O1 O2 3
Identify the materials used in
CO1 3 3 3 3 2 1 1 - 2 2 2 2 3 2 3
the product
Carryout confirmative tests to
CO2 identify specifications of 3 3 3 3 2 1 1 - 2 2 2 2 3 2 3
materials used
Suggest the production process
CO3 3 3 3 3 2 1 1 - 2 2 2 2 3 2 3
required to make the product
CO4 Costing of product 3 3 3 3 2 1 1 - 2 2 2 2 3 2 3
Overall CO 3 3 3 3 2 1 1 - 2 2 2 2 3 2 3
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
119
TT3711 INDUSTRIAL TRAINING / INTERNSHIP II## LTPC
000 2
OBJECTIVES:
To enable the students to
Get connected with industry/ laboratory/research institute
Get practical knowledge on production process in the industry and develop skills to solve
related problems
Develop skills to carry out research in the research institutes/laboratories
The students individually undergo training in reputed firms/ research institutes / laboratories for the
specified duration. After the completion of training, a detailed report should be submitted within ten
days from the commencement of next semester. The students will be evaluated as per the
Regulations.
No.of. Weeks: 04
OUTCOMES:
On completion of the course, the student will know about
CO1: Plant layout, machinery, organizational structure and production processes in the firm or
research facilities in the laboratory/research institute
CO2: Analysis of industrial / research problems and their solutions
CO3: Documenting of material specifications, machine and process parameters, testing
parameters and results
CO4: Preparing of Technical report and presentation
OUTCOME:
Upon completion of the course, the students will be able to
CO1: Explain pattern making, grading and marker planning
CO2: Demonstrate the spreading and cutting process, and classify the stitches and seams for
various applications
CO3: Discuss the functions of various sewing machines
CO4: Elaborate on garment pressing, packing, trims and accessories
CO5: Explain various types of furnishing materials and applications
CO6: Select the appropriate seams and stitches for various end uses.
CO7: Construct basic T shirt, basic skirt and baby frock
TEXTBOOKS
1. Carr H., and Latham B., “The Technology of Clothing Manufacture”, Blackwell Science Ltd.,
Oxford, 1994, ISBN: 0632037482.
2. Winifred Aldrich., “Metric Pattern Cutting”, Blackwell Science Ltd., Oxford, 2004, ISBN:
1405102780 | ISBN-13: 9781405102780
3. Subrata Das., Performance of Home Textiles, Wood head Publishing India PVT. LTD,
2010.
REFERENCES
1. Peggal H., “The Complete Dress Maker”, Marshall Caverdish, London, 1985.
2. Gerry Cooklin., Steven George Hayes., and John McLoughlin, “Introduction to Clothing
Manufacture”, Blackwell Scientific Publications, London, 2006, ISBN: 0632058463 |
ISBN13: 9780632058464.
3. Jai Prakash., and Gaur R.K., “Sewing Thread”, NITRA, 1994.
4. Ruth E. Glock., and Grace I. Kunz., “Apparel Manufacturing – Sewn Product Analysis”
4th Edition, Upper Sadle River Publications, New York, 2004. ISBN: 0131119826 |
ISBN-13: 9780131119826
5. Pradip V. Mehta., “An Introduction to Quality Control for the Apparel Industry”, J.S.N.
Internationals, 1992, ISBN: B015X4YG
121
Course Articulation Matrix:
Program
Course Outcome
Statement
Outcomes PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO
PO1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2 PSO3
Explain pattern making, grading,
CO1 marker planning, spreading and 3 1 2 2 1 - - - - - - 1 2 2 2
cutting
Demonstrate the spreading and
cutting process, and classify the
CO2 3 1 2 2 1 - - - - - - 1 2 2 2
stitches and seams for various
applications
Discuss the functions of various
CO3 sewing machines 3 1 2 2 1 - - - - - - 1 2 2 2
Elaborate on garment pressing,
CO4 packing, trims and accessories 3 1 2 2 1 - - - - - - 1 2 2 2
Analyze the various types of
CO5 furnishing materials and applications 3 1 2 2 1 - - - - - - 1 2 2 2
Select the appropriate seams and
CO6 3 3 3 - 1 - - - 2 2 2 2 3 3 3
stitches for various end uses.
Construct basic T shirt, basic skirt
CO7 and baby frock 3 3 3 - 1 2 2 2 2 3 3 3
Overall CO 3 1.57 2.28 2 1 - - - 2 2 2 1.28 2.28 2.28 2.28
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
122
TT3752 FINANCIAL MANAGEMENT FOR TEXTILE INDUSTRIES LTPC
3003
OBJECTIVES:
To enable the students to understand
Basics of financial management which are required for the textile industry
Determination of cost of yarn, fabric and garment
TEXTBOOKS
1. Pandey I. M., “Financial Management”,Vikas Publishing House Pvt. Ltd., New Delhi, 10 th
Edition, 2010, ISBN: 8125937145 / ISBN: 9788125937142.
2. Bhave P.V., and Srinivasan V., “Costing Accounting to Textile Mills”, ATIRA, Ahmadabad, 1976
REFERENCES
1. Thukaram Rao M.E., “Cost and Management Accounting” NewAge International, Bangalore,
2004, ISBN: 812241513X / ISBN: 978-8122415131.
2. Thukaram Rao M.E., “Cost Accounting and Financial Management” New Age International,
Bangalore, 2004, ISBN: 8122415148/ ISBN: 978-8122415148.
3. Prasanna Chandra., “Financial Management - Theory and Practice”, 8th Edition, Tata
McGraw- Hill Publishing Company Ltd, New Delhi, 2011, ISBN :0071078401 / ISBN:
0071078401.62
4. James C. Vanhorne., “Financial Management and Policy”, Pearson Education Asia (Low
Priced Edition) 12th Edition, 2002, ISBN: 0130326577 | ISBN-13: 9780130326577.
123
5. Narang, G. B. S., and Kumar V., “Production and Costing”, Khanna Publishers, New Delhi,
1988, ISBN: 8174092897 | ISBN-13: 9788174092892
6. Aswat Damodaran., “Corporate Finance Theory and Practice”, John Wiley & Sons,
2001,ISBN: 0471283320 | ISBN-13: 9780471283324.
7. Hrishikes Bhattacharya., “Working Capital Management, Strategies and Techniques”,
Prentice Hall of India Pvt. Ltd., New Delhi, 2014, ISBN: 8120349040 | ISBN-13:
9788120349049.
8. Khan and Jain, “Basic Financial Management and Practice”, Tata McGraw Hill, New Delhi,7th
Edition, 2014, ISBN: 933921305X / ISBN: 978-9339213053.
9. Kantwala D.N., “Costing and Cost Control – A Marginal Approach for Textile Industry”,
Texcons, Bombay, 1977.
124
Course Articulation Matrix:
Program
Course Outcome
Statement
Outcomes PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO
PO1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2 PSO3
Explain the types and methods
CO1 of costing, and preparation of 3 3 1 2 2 - - - - 2 2 1 3 2 1
cost sheet
Determine the cost of yarn,
CO2 3 3 1 2 2 - - - - 2 2 1 3 2 1
fabrics and garments
Carryout investment appraisal and
CO3 calculate depreciation 3 3 1 2 2 - - - - 2 2 1 3 2 1
Describe the different sources and
CO4 cost of capital, and preparation of 3 3 1 2 2 - - - - 2 2 1 3 2 1
budget
Analyze and interpret the
CO5 financial statements of textile 3 3 1 2 2 - - - - 2 2 1 3 2 1
company
Overall CO 3 3 1 2 2 - - - - 2 2 1 3 2 1
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
125
GE3791 HUMAN VALUES AND ETHICS LT P C
2 0 0 2
COURSE DESCRIPTION
This course aims to provide a broad understanding about the modern values and ethical principles
that have evolved and are enshrined in the Constitution of India with regard to the democratic,
secular and scientific aspects. The course is designed for undergraduate students so that they
could study, understand and apply these values in their day to day life.
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
To create awareness about values and ethics enshrined in the Constitution of India
To sensitize students about the democratic values to be upheld in the modern society.
To inculcate respect for all people irrespective of their religion or other affiliations.
To instill the scientific temper in the students’ minds and develop their critical thinking.
To promote sense of responsibility and understanding of the duties of citizen.
Reading Text: Excerpt from Secularism in India: Concept and Practice by Ram Puniyani
Reading Text: Excerpt from 21 Lessons for the 21st Century by Yuval Noah Harari
Reading Text: Excerpt from American Prometheus: The Triumph and Tragedy of J.Robert
Oppenheimer by Kai Bird and Martin J. Sherwin.
TOTAL: 30 PERIODS
REFERENCES:
1. The Nonreligious: Understanding Secular People and Societies, Luke W. Galen Oxford
University Press, 2016.
2. Secularism: A Dictionary of Atheism, Bullivant, Stephen; Lee, Lois, Oxford University Press,
2016.
126
3. The Oxford Handbook of Secularism, John R. Shook, Oxford University Press, 2017.
4. The Civic Culture: Political Attitudes and Democracy in Five Nations by Gabriel A. Almond and
Sidney Verba, Princeton University Press,
5. Research Methodology for Natural Sciences by Soumitro Banerjee, IISc Press, January 2022
COURSE OUTCOMES
Students will be able to
CO1 : Identify the importance of democratic, secular and scientific values in harmonious
functioning of social life
CO2 : Practice democratic and scientific values in both their personal and professional life.
CO3 : Find rational solutions to social problems.
CO4 : Behave in an ethical manner in society
CO5 : Practice critical thinking and the pursuit of truth.
127
TT3811 PROJECT WORK / INTERNSHIP# LT P C
0 0 20 10
OBJECTIVES:
To train the students in
Identifying problem and developing the structured methodology to solve the identified
problem in the industry or research problem at research Institution or college.
Conducting experiments, analyze and discuss the test results, and make conclusions.
Preparing project reports and presentation
The students shall individually / or as group work on a specific topic approved by the
Department. The student can select any topic which is relevant to his/her specialization of the
programme. The student should continue the work on the selected topic as per the formulated
methodology. At the end of the semester, after completing the work to the satisfaction of the
supervisor and review committee, a detailed report which contains clear definition of the
identified problem, detailed literature review related to the area of work and methodology for
carrying out the work, results and discussion, conclusion and references should be prepared as
per the format prescribed by the University and submitted to the Head of the department. The
students will be evaluated based on the report and viva-voce examination by a panel of
examiners as per the Regulations.
TOTAL: 300 PERIODS
OUTCOMES:
At the end of the project, the student will be able to
CO1: Formulate and analyze problem / create a new product/ process.
CO2: Design and conduct experiments to find solution
CO3: Analyze the results and provide solution for the identified problem, prepare project report
and make presentation
128
Course Articulation Matrix
Program
Course Outcome
Statement
Outcomes PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PSO
PO1 PO2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 O1 O2 3
Formulating and solving probllmes
CO1 3 3 3 3 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 1 3 2 3
related to Spinning and weaving
CO2 Fibre scienceand processing 3 3 3 3 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 1 3 2 3
CO3 Knitting andNonwovens 3 3 3 3 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 1 3 2 3
Nanotechnology ogy application in
CO4 3 3 3 3 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 1 3 2 3
textiles
CO5 Technical Textiles 3 3 3 3 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 1 3 2 3
Overall CO 3 3 3 3 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 1 3 2 3
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
129
PROFESSIONAL ELECTIVES
Spinning ,Weaving
CTT343 PROCESS AND QUALITY CONTROL IN SPINNING L T P C
3 0 0 3
OBJECTIVES:
To make the students understand;
Quality aspects of raw materials
Process control measures in spinning
Productivity limits of spinning machinery
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Thilagavathi G & Karthik T, "Process control and yarn quality in spinning", Woodhead Publishing
130
India, New Delhi, 2015.
2. Garde A R and Subramanian T A, "Process Control in Spinning", ATIRA, Ahmedabad, 1989.
REFERENCES:
1. Majumdar, Das, Alagirusamy, Kothari, "Process control in textile manufacturing", Woodhead
Publishing, UK, 2012.
2. Ratnam T V. and Chellamani. K. P., "Quality Control in Spinning", SITRA, Coimbatore, 1999.
3. K.R.Salhotra, "Spinning of manmade fibres and blends on cotton system", 3rd Edition, TAI
PUBLICATIONS, Mumbai, India, 2004.
4. Senthilkumar R, "Process Management in Spinning", CRC Press, UK, 2019.
131
Course Articulation Matrix:
Course Program Outcome
Statement PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO
Outcomes PO1 PSO3
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2
Selection of raw material with
CO1 3 3 3 3 2 1 1 1 - - - 2 3 2 2
optimize quality for spinning industry
Improving ofn yarn realization by
CO2 minimization of process waste and 3 3 3 3 2 1 1 1 - - - 2 3 2 2
setting optimal process parameters.
Control of Count, strength, hairiness,
evenness and imperfections and
CO3 3 3 3 3 2 1 1 1 - - - 2 3 2 2
analysis of
quality charts
Measures to be taken while
CO4 processing manmade fibres and 3 3 3 3 2 1 1 1 - - - 2 3 2 2
blends
Method of computation of productivity
indices and improve yarn productivity
CO5 3 3 3 3 2 1 1 1 - - - 2 3 2 2
by proper machine balancing and
maintaining parameters
Overall CO 3 3 3 3 2 1 1 1 - - - 2 3 2 2
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
132
CTT342 PROCESS AND QUALITY CONTROL IN FABRIC MANUFACTURE L T P C
3 0 0 3
OBJECTIVES:
To make the students understand
Process control measures in weaving preparatory to meet the required yarn quality
Factors influencing loom production efficiency
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Alagirusamy R, Das A, Majumdar A, Kothari V K , "Process Control in Manufacturing", Wood
Head Publishing, UK, 2012.
2. Paliwal M C and Kimothi.P D , "Process Control in Weaving", ATIRA Publication, Ahmedabad,
1983.
REFERENCES:
1. BTRA, "Loom Shed", BTRA Publications, Mumbai, 1986.
2. BTRA, "Warping and Sizing", BTRA Publications, Mumbai, 1983.
3. BTRA, "Winding", BTRA Publications, Mumbai, 1986.
133
Course Articulation Matrix:
Course Program Outcome
Statement PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO
Outcomes PO1 PSO3
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2
Control productivity and quality
CO1 3 3 3 3 2 1 1 1 - - - 2 3 2 2
in winding
Discuss the process control in
CO2 warping 3 3 3 3 2 1 1 1 - - - 2 3 2 2
Explain the quality and process
CO3 control in sizing 3 3 3 3 2 1 1 1 - - - 2 3 2 2
Control the quality in drawing-in
CO4 and tyeing 3 3 3 3 2 1 1 1 - - - 2 3 2 2
Improve loom efficiency and cloth
CO5 realization 3 3 3 3 2 1 1 1 - - - 2 3 2 2
Overall CO 3 3 3 3 2 1 1 1 - - - 2 3 2 2
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
134
CTT353 THEORY OF DRAFTING AND TWISTING LTPC
3003
OBJECTIVES:
To enable the students understand the theory of drafting and twisting involved in spinning
system.
REFERENCES:
1. Grosberg P and lype C. Yarn Production: Theoretical Aspects, The Textile Institute,
Manchester, 1999.
2. De Barr A.E. and Catling H., The Principle and Theory of Ring Spinning, The Textile Institute,
Manchester, 1965.
135
Course Articulation Matrix:
Course Program Outcome
Statement PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO
Outcomes PO1 PSO3
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2
Describe the concept of Ideal
CO1 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
drafting and real drafting
Explain the phenomenon of roller
CO2 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
slip and roller nip movement
Describe the principle of wire point
CO3 drafting and its comparison with 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
roller drafting and applications
Elucidate the fundamentals of false
CO4 twisting and real twisting; twisting in 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
ring spinning
Describe the theory of twist formation
CO5 in rotor spinning, air jet and air vortex 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
spinning systems
Overall CO 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
136
CTT344 PRODUCTION AND APPLICATION OF SEWING THREADS LTPC
3003
OBJECTIVES:
To enable the students to
Understand the requirements and production of sewing threads for different applications.
Understand types of fancy and metallic yarns.
Carrryout tests to ensure the quality of sewing threads.
TEXTBOOKS
1. Ukponmwan J.O., Mukhopadhyay A., and Chatterjee K.N., “Sewing threads”, Textile
Progress, 2000, ISBN: 1870372387 | ISBN-13: 9781870372381.
2. Carl A Lawrence., “Fundamentals of Spun Yarn Technology”, CRC Press, Florida, USA,
2003, ISBN: 1566768217 | ISBN-13: 9781566768214
3. Carr H., “The Technology of Clothing Manufacture”, Blackwell Publisher, UK, 2004, ISBN:
4. 0632021934 | ISBN-13: 9780632021932
REFERENCES
1. Ruth E. Glock., “Apparel Manufacturing Sewn Product Analysis”, Prentice Hall, New Jersey,
2005, ISBN: 0131119826 | ISBN-13: 9780131119826
2. Jacob Solinger., “Apparel Production Handbook”, Reinhold Publications, 1998, ISBN:
1879570009 / ISBN: 978-1879570009
3. Rao J.V., and Rajendra Kr.Gaur., “Sewing Threads: Technology, Stitches, Seams,
Problems, Needles”, NITRA, 2006.
4. Gong R.H., and Wright R.M., “Fancy yarns –Their manufacture and application”, Woodhead
Publishing Ltd, England, 2002, ISBN: 0849315506 | ISBN-13: 9780849315503.
137
Course Articulation Matrix
Program Outcome
Course
Statement PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PSO
Outcomes PO1 PO2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 O1 O2 3
Describe the characteristics of
CO1 3 3 1 1 1 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
sewing thread
Explain the production of sewing
CO2 thread 3 3 1 1 1 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
Discuss the manufacturing of
CO3 3 3 1 1 1 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
ply and fancy yarns
Explain the characteristics of
CO4 high performance sewing 3 3 1 1 1 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
threads
Describe the testing and quality
CO5 assurance of sewing threads 3 3 1 1 1 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
Overall CO 3 3 1 1 1 - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
138
CTT357 STRUCTURAL MECHANICS OF YARNS AND FABRICS LTPC
3003
OBJECTIVES:
To make the students learn about the structure of ideal and real yarn, migration of fibres in the
yarn, mechanics of blended yarns.
To impart the knowledge about breakage mechanism of various yarns, relationship between
structure and property of staple fibre yarns and continuous filaments.
To make the students to learn and understand the geometry of woven, knitted and nonwoven
fabrics, and structure influence on the mechanical properties of woven fabric
139
REFERENCES:
1. Hearl J. W. S., "Structural Mechanics of Fibers, Yarns and Fabrics", Wiley Inter science,
New York, 1969, ISBN: 0471366692.
2. Hearle J. W. S., John J., Thwaites. and JafargholiAmirbayat., "Mechanics of Flexible Fibre
Assemblies", Sijthoff and Noordhoff, 1980, ISBN: 902860720X.
3. Jinlian Hu., "Structure and Mechanics of Woven Fabrics", Woodhead Publishing Ltd., 2004,
ISBN: 1855739046.
4. Hassan M. Berery., "Effect of Mechanical and Physical properties on Fabrics Hand",
Woodhead publishing Ltd., 2005, ISBN: 13: 978 – 1- 85573 -9185.
140
Course Articulation Matrix:
Program Outcome
Course
Statement PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO
Outcomes PO1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2 PSO3
Discuss the packing of fibres
CO1 and yarn structure 3 3 2 2 2 1 1 - - - - 1 3 1 2
Analyse the continuous
CO2 filament properties. 3 3 2 2 2 1 1 - - - - 1 3 1 2
Explain the staple fibre yarn’s
CO3 3 3 2 2 2 1 1 - - - - 1 3 1 2
tensile properties
Demonstrate the models
proposed for geometry of
CO4 woven fabrics and 3 3 2 2 2 1 1 - - - - 1 3 1 2
characteristics of fabric on
deformation
Explain the structural
CO5 characteristics of knitted 3 3 2 2 2 1 1 - - - - 1 3 1 2
and nonwovens
Overall CO 3 3 2 2 2 1 1 - - - - 1 3 1 2
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
141
Chemical Processing
143
Garment Manufacturing
TEXTBOOKS
1. Harold Carr., and Barbara latham., “The Technology of Clothing Manufacture”, 4th Edition,
Whiley-Black well Sciences, 2008, ISBN: 1405161981 / ISBN: 978-1405161985
2. Jacob Solinger., “Apparel Manufacturing Handbook”, 2nd Edition Bobbin Blenheim Media
Corp, 1988, ISBN : 1879570009 / ISBN: 978-1879570009
REFERENCES
1. Ruth E. Glock., and Grace I. Kunz., “Apparel Manufacturing Sewn Product Analysis”, 4th
Edition, Pearson Prentice Hall, 2005, ISBN: 0131119826 | ISBN-13: 9780131119826
2. Villumsone-Nemes I., “Industrial Cutting of Textiles material”, Wood head Publications Pvt.
Ltd 2012, ISBN: 978-1-85709-134-5
3. JelkaGersak., “Design of Clothing Manufacture Process - A Systematic Approach to
Planning Scheduling and Control”, Wood head Publications Pvt. Ltd, 2013, ISBN: 978-1-
85709-778-1
144
Course Articulation Matrix:
Course Statement Program Outcome
Outcom PO1 PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO PSO3
es 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2
CO1 Fundamental principle and 2 3 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 2 1 2 3 3
working of
machines used for
spreading and cutting
CO2 Stitch formation and 3 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 2 1 2 3 3
other mechanisms of
SNLS machine and
chain stitch machine
CO3 Principle of button 2 3 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 2 1 2 3 3
fixing and button
holing machines
CO4 Stitch formation and 3 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 2 1 2 3 3
other mechanisms of
overlock, flatlock and
other special sewing
machines
CO5 Different types of 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 2 1 2 3 3
finishing machines
used for garments
Overall CO 2.57 2.28 1.14 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 2 1 2 3 3
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
145
FT3692 INDUSTRIAL ENGINEERING IN GARMENT MANUFACTURING LTPC
3003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
To enable the students to learn about basics of industrial engineering
To provide knowledge on different tools of industrial engineering and its application in
apparel industry
UNIT I 9
Industrial Engineering - evolution, functions, role of industrial engineer; productivity concepts,
causes for low productivity in apparel industry, suggestions for productivity improvement; basic
work content, added work content, reduction of work content and ineffective time, work study-
introduction and procedure.
UNIT II 13
Methods study - introduction, techniques of recording; method analysis techniques; principles of
motion economy; method study in garment manufacture; ergonomics - importance, workplace
design, fatigue
UNIT III 13
Work measurement – introduction; time study – equipment and procedure; standard data;
predetermined time standards; work sampling techniques; incentive wage system; work
measurement applied to garment industry- calculation of SAM
UNIT IV 5
Site selection for textile industry; plant layout - types of layouts suitable for textile industry,
methods to construct layout; line balancing
UNIT V 5
Statistical Process Control – data collection; concept of AQL, control charts in quality control;
process capability
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
Upon completion of this course, the student would be able to
CO1: Understand the basics of industrial engineering and productivity concepts
CO2: Method study and its techniques
CO3: Applywork measurement
CO4: Understand the concepts of layout and line balancing
CO5: Interpret the result using statistical process control
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Khanna O. P. and Sarup A., “Industrial Engineering and Management”,
DhanpatRaiPublications, New Delhi, 2005
2. George Kanwaty, “Introduction to Work Study", ILO, Geneva, 1989
3. Norberd Lloyd Enrick, “Industrial Engineering Manual for Textile Industry”, Wiley Eastern
(P)Ltd., New Delhi, 1988
4. Enrick N. L., “Time study manual for Textile industry”, Wiley Eastern (P) Ltd., 1989
REFERENCES:
1. Chuter A. J., “Introduction to Clothing Production Management”, Black well Science, U.
S.A., 1995
2. Richard I. Levin. and David S. Rubin., “Statistics for Management”, 7th Edition,
PrenticeHall of India Pvt. Ltd., New Delhi, 1997
146
3. David M. Levine, Timothy C. Krehbiel and Mark L. Berenson., “Business Statistics: A
FirstCourse”, Pearson Education Asia, New Delhi, 2nd Edition, 2000
4. Panneerselvam R., “Production and Operation Management”, Prentice Hall of India, 2002
5. Edward S. Buffa and RakeshSarin., “Modern Production and Operations
Management”,John Wiley & Sons, U. S. A., 1987
6. Lee J. Krajewski and Larry P. Ritzman., “Operations Management: Strategy and
Analysis”,Addison Wesley, 2000
7. Chase, Aquilano and Jacobs., “Production and Operations Management”, Tata McGraw-
Hill, New Delhi, 8th Edition, 1999
147
Course Articulation Matrix:
Program Outcome
Course Statement PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO PSO
Outcomes
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2 3
Understand the
CO1 basics of 3 3 2 2 2 1 1 2 1 1 - - 3 2 2
industrial
engineering
Gain knowledge
CO2 on method study 2 2 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 1 - - 3 2 3
and its techniques
Acquire knowledge
CO3 on work 2 2 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 1 - - 3 2 3
measurement
Understand the
CO4 concepts of layout 2 2 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 1 - - 3 2 3
and line balancing
Interpret the result
CO5 using statistical 2 3 3 3 3 1 1 1 1 1 - - 3 2 3
process control
Overall CO 2.2 2.4 2.8 2.8 2.8 1.6 1.6 1.8 1.6 1 - - 3 2 2.8
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
148
FT3404 PATTERN ENGINEERING LTPC
3003
COURSE OBJECTIVES
To enhance the fundamental knowledge in human anthropometrics from the scientific and
technological viewpoint
To equip students with comprehensive pattern making skills
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Harrold Carr., and Barbara Latham., “The Technology of Clothing Manufacture” Backwell
Science, U.K., 1994,ISBN: 0632037482 | ISBN-13: 9780632037483.
2. Gerry Cooklin., Steven George Hayes., and John McLoughlin., “Introduction to Clothing
Manufacture”, Wiley-Blackwell Science, U.K., 2006, ISBN: 0632058463 | ISBN-
13:9780632058464.
3. Helen Joseph Armstrong, “Pattern Making for Fashion Design” Pearson Education
(Singapore)Pvt. Ltd.,2005 2. Winifred Aldrich, “Metric Pattern Cutting” Blackwell Science
Ltd., 1994
149
REFERENCES:
1. Gerry Cooklin, “Master Patterns and Grading for Women’s Outsizes”, Blackwell Scientific
Publications, 1995.
2. Gerry Cooklin, “Master Patterns and Grading for Men’s Outsize”, Blackwell Scientific
Publications, 1992.
3. Jeenne Price and Bernard Zamkoff, “Grading Techniques for Modern Design” Fairchild
Publications, 1990.
4. Amaden-Crawford Connie, “The Art of Fashion Draping (3rd edition)” Om Books
International Publications, 2005
5. Winifred Aldrich, “Metric Pattern Cutting” Blackwell Science Ltd., 1994
150
Course Articulation Matrix:
Overall CO 2 2 2 2 3 - - - 1 - - - 2 - 2
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
151
FT3691 APPAREL MARKETING AND MERCHANDISING LTPC
3003
COURSE OBJECTIVES
To acquaint the students with the concepts of Fashion business, design merchandising,
sourcing and export documentation
UNIT IV SOURCING 9
Understanding the basics of sourcing, sourcing strategy and best sourcing practice in apparel and
textile businesses, supply chain and demand chain, sourcing negotiations, global co-ordination in
sourcing, materials management and quality in sourcing, quick response, ERP, supplier
partnership in sourcing, JIT technology, made to fit.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Elian stone, Jean A samples, “Fashion Merchandising”, McGraw Hill Book Company, New
York, 1985, ISBN: 0-07-061742-2
2. Gibson G. Vedamani, “Retail Management Functional Principles
andPractices”,JaicoPublishingHouse,SecondEdition,2002
3. Ruth E. Glock, Grace I. Kunz “Apparel Manufacturing Sewn Product Analysis” Fourth
Edition, Pearson Prentice Hall, NJ, 2005, ISBN: 81-7758-076-0
152
REFERENCES:
1. Shivaramu S.,” Export Marketing” – A Practical Guide to Exporters”, Wheeler Publishing,
Ohio, 1996, ISBN: 81-7544-166-6
2. Warren. J. Keegan and Mark.C.Green , “Global Marketing”, Pearson Prentice Hall, New
Delhi, 2005.
3. Philip Kotler, Kevin Lane Keller, Abraham Koshy, and Mithileshwar Jha , “Marketing
Management A South Asian Perspective”, Pearson Education, New Delhi, 2006
4. NairSuja.R,"RetailManagement",HimalayaPublishingHouse,2008.
5. John Donnellan “Merchandise Buying and Management”, Farichild
Publications,inc.,NewYork,2002
Course Program
Outcome Outcome
s PS PS
PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO PO PS
O O
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 11 12 O3
1 2
CO1 3 2 2 2 1 2 - - - - - - 2 3 -
CO2 3 2 2 2 1 2 - - - - - - 2 3 -
CO3 3 2 2 2 1 2 - - - - - - 2 3 -
CO4 3 2 2 2 1 2 - - - - - - 2 3 -
CO5 3 2 2 2 1 2 - - - - - - 2 3 -
Overall
3 2 2 2 1 2 - - - - - - 2 3 -
CO
153
Course Articulation Matrix:
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
154
CTT362 APPAREL PRODUCT DEVELOPMENT LABORATORY LTPC
0063
OBJECTIVES:
To enable the students, to construct different garment components.
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Sewing practice of stitch classes.
2. Sewing practice of seam types
3. Sewing of different types of plackets
4. Sewing of different types of pockets
5. Sewing of different types of sleeves
6. Sewing of different types of collars and cuff
7. Sewing of different types of neckline finishes.
8. Sewing of different types of pleats, tucks and gathers
9. Construct a men’s shirt
10. Construct a men’s trousers
11. Construct a women’s skirt
TOTAL: 90 PERIODS
OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of this course, the students will be able to
CO1: Make different seams and stitches
CO2: Make different cut component and parts of basic garment
CO3: Carryout sewing of cut component assembly in to basic garment
155
Course Articulation Matrix:
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
156
CTT361 BASIC SEWING AND PATTERN MAKING LABORATORY LTPC
0063
OBJECTIVES:
To enable the students to get practical experience in understanding sewing machine components
and to practically carryout pattern making
LIST OF EXPERIMENTS
1. Identification of single needle lockstitch machine (SNLS) components and understanding their
functions.
2. Needle fixing and threading in single needle, double needle, over-lock, flat lock and feed-of
the-arm machine.
3. Practice for pedal and knee lifter operations and winding the bobbin thread.
4. Sewing exercise on paper in SNLS - Exercise 1 - Parallel line - Exercise 2 - Square -
Exercise 3 - Curves - Exercise 4 - Concentric curves
5. Stitching exercise on fabric panels in SNLS - Exercise 1 - Parallel line - Exercise 2 - Square -
Exercise 3 - Curves - Exercise 4 - Concentric curves
6. Prepare samples in SNLS machine by varying the stitch length and thread tension.
7. Measuring the Dress Form – Male, female and child and formulating the measurement charts
8. Drafting the basic blocks of male
9. Drafting the basic blocks of female
10. Grading of basic block.
11. Drafting of men’s shirt
12. Drafting of men’s trousers.
TOTAL: 90 PERIODS
OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of this practical course, the student shall be able to
CO1. Identify the machine components and understand the basic settings in single needle
machine
CO2. Identify the machine components and understand the basic settings in flatlock and feed off
arm machine
CO3. Sew on line markings in paper using single needle lockstitch machine
CO4. Sew on fabric panels in single needle lockstitch machine
CO5. Draft the basic block and grade the same
157
Course Articulation Matrix:
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
158
Management of Textile Industries
UNIT I 9
Introduction – History of Operations Research, Scope of Operation Research, applications and
limitations; Linear programming problem – construction, solution by graphical method, the Simplex
method and its extension by the Big M method; integer programming – introduction; application of
the LP technique in the field of Textile technology
UNIT II 9
Transportation problem – construction, initial basic feasible solution – North West Corner rule,
lowest cost entry method, Vogel’s Approximation Method; the optimality test - Modified Distribution
method, stepping stone method; transshipment problems
UNIT III 9
The Assignment problem – construction, solution by Hungarian method, application in the textile
industry; sequencing problems; from textile industry Decisions theory - decisions under assumed
certainty, decision under risk, decision under uncertainty, illustrations from textile industry
UNIT IV 9
Replacement analysis; inventory control – ABC, VED analysis, EOQ – application in textile
industry, simulation-introduction, Monte Carlo method
UNIT V 9
Project planning and control models: CPM, PERT – network representation, determining critical
path, project duration; crashing of project duration; resource leveling
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
Upon completion of the course, the students will be able to
CO1: Design Operations Research problems from the cases arising in the Textile Industry and
determine solution for linear programming problems
CO2: Construct and solve transportation problems
CO3: Construct and solve assignment problems and understand decision making under different
conditions.
CO4: Carryout replacement analysis and inventory control
CO5: Construct and solve project scheduling by PERT and CPM techniques and resource leveling
TEXTBOOKS
1. Ronald L. and Rardin., “Optimization in Operations Research”, Pearson Education,
1998,ISBN: 0023984155 | ISBN-13: 9780023984150
2. Srivastava U.K., Shenoy G.V., and Sharma S. C., “Quantitative Techniques for
ManagerialDecisions”, Second Edition, New Age International (P) Ltd., 2007, ISBN:
0470273755 | ISBN- 13: 9780470273753
3. Panneerselvam R., “Operations Research”, Prentice-Hall of India Pvt. Ltd; 2nd
159
Edition, 2004,ISBN : 8120319230 / ISBN: 978-8120329287
REFERENCES
1. Frederick S. Hillier., Gerald J. Lieberman., Frederick Hillier., and Gerald
Lieberman.,“Introduction to Operations Research”, McGraw-Hill International Edition,
8th Edition, 2004, ISBN: 0073017795 / ISBN: 978-0073017792
2. Hamdy A Taha., “Operations Research – An Introduction”, Prentice Hall, 9thEdition,
2010 ISBN: 013255593X | ISBN-13: 9780132555937.
3. Fabrycky W. J.,Ghare P. M., and Torgersen P. E., “Applied Operation Research
andManagement Science”, Prentice Hall, New Jersey, 1984, ISBN: 013041459X /
ISBN: 9780130414595.
4. Tulsian P.C., “Quantitative Techniques Theory and Problems”, Dorling Kindersley
(India) Pvt.Ltd., 2006, ISBN: 8131701867 | ISBN-13: 9788131701867
160
Course Articulation Matrix:
Program
Course Outcome
Statement
Outcomes PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO
PO1 PSO3
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2
Design Operations Research
problems from the cases arising in the
CO1 Textile Industry and determine 3 2 2 3 3 - - - - 1 2 1 3 3 2
solution for linear programming
problems
Construct and solve transportation
CO2 3 2 2 3 3 - - - - 1 2 1 3 3 2
problems
Construct and solve assignment
CO3 problems and understand decision 3 2 2 3 3 - - - - 1 2 1 3 3 2
making under different conditions.
Carryout replacement analysis and
CO4 3 2 2 3 3 - - - - 1 2 1 3 3 2
inventory control
Construct and solve project
CO5 scheduling by PERT and CPM 3 2 2 3 3 - - - - 1 2 1 3 3 2
techniques andresource leveling
Overall CO 3 2 2 3 3 - - - - 1 2 1 3 3 2
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
161
CTT347 SUPPLY CHAIN MANAGEMENT LTPC
3003
OBJECTIVES:
To provide an insight on the fundamentals of supply chain networks, tools and
techniques.
To train the students to new and recent developments in supply chains, e-business and
information technology
UNIT I 9
Basic principles of supply chain management and logistics, supply chain models, supply chain for
volatile market; supply chain drivers and metrics in apparel industries; roll of supply chain in the
textile and apparel industries’ financial stability.
UNIT II 9
Planning supply and demand in apparel production house, managing economies of scale, supply
cycle and inventory levels; managing uncertainty in supply chain, safety pricing and inventory;
make vs buy decision, make vs hire decision; geographical identification of suppliers, supplier
evaluation, supplier selection, contract negotiations and finalization.
UNIT III 9
Distribution network and design for global textile and apparel products, models of distribution –
facility location and allocation of capacity, uncertainty on design and network optimization; the role
of transportation in supply chain, modes of transportation, characteristics of transportation,
transport design options for global textile and apparel network, trade-off in transport design, risk
management in transportation, transport decision in practice for textile and apparel industries.
UNIT IV 9
Coordination in supply chain- the bullwhip effect, forecasting, obstacles to coordination in supply
chain; supply chain management for apparel retail stores, high fashion fad; supply chain in e-
business and b2b practices
UNIT V 9
Import - export management, documentation, insurance, packing and foreign exchange; methods
of payments – domestic, international, commercial terms; dispute handling modes and channels;
supply chain and Information system; customer relationship management
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of this course, the student shall have the
CO1 Knowledge on the basic frame work of supply chain management
CO2 Understanding the economics of supply and demand cycle
CO3 Knowledge on its functions in the industry
CO4 Understanding on coordination of supply chain management
CO5 Understanding supply chain management with apparel export and import
TEXT BOOKS:
1. David Simchi-Levi., Philip Kaminsky., and Edith Simchi-Levi., “Designing and Managing
the Supply Chain: Concepts, Strategies, and Cases”, 3rd Edition, Tata McGraw-Hill,
2012, ISBN: 0073341525 / ISBN: 978-0073341521
2. Altekar Rahul V., “Supply Chain Management-Concept and Cases”, PHI, 2005, ASIN:
B00K7YGX2S
162
REFERENCES:
1. Janat Shah., “Supply Chain Management – Text and Cases”, Pearson Education,
2009, ISBN: 8131715175 | ISBN-13: 9788131715178
2. Peter Meindl., Kalra D. V., Kalra D., and Sunil Chopra “Supply Chain Management-
Strategy Planning and Operation”, Pearson Education, 2010, ISBN: 8131730719 |
ISBN-13: 9788131730713
163
Course Articulation Matrix:
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
164
CTT336 ENTERPRISE RESOURCE PLANNING FOR GARMENT INDUSTRY LTPC
0063
OBJECTIVE
To enable the students understand about the Enterprise Resource Planning software and its
modules
List of experiments
Practice on data entry, report generation in Enterprise Resource Planning software
1. Costing, order booking, MRP, purchase, production planning, production orders, inventory
control, packing, shipping, scheduling, sample preparation and approval, business reports
2. ERP in apparel production – time study, cutting, production tracking, cut panel process,
garment quality control, order completion, machine repairs and maintenance, reports
3. ERP in retail management – style template, finished goods barcoding, stock taking, stock
inward, retail order booking, stock allocation, scan and pack, dispatch, invoice, point of sale,
reports
TOTAL: 90 PERIODS
OUTCOME:
Upon the completion of this course the students shall be able to
CO1: Understand the structure of ERP software
CO2: Data entry in ERP software
CO3: Creating records and managing information at different section of apparel industry for
decision making
165
Course Articulation Matrix:
Course Statement Program Outcome
Outcomes PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO
PO1 PO3 PSO3
2 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2
CO1 Understand the - - 2 - 3 - - 2 2 1 2 1 - 2 -
structure of ERP
software
CO2 Data entry in ERP - - 2 - 3 - - 2 2 1 2 1 - 2 -
software
CO3 Creating records - - 2 - 3 - - 2 2 1 3 1 - 2 -
and managing
information at
different section of
apparel industry
for decision
making
Overall CO - - 2.25 - 3 - - 2 2 1 2.5 1 - 2 -
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
166
CTT354 APPAREL COSTING LTPC
3003
OBJECTIVES:
To learn apparel costing, budgeting and working capital management
UNIT I 9
Cost accounting, elements of cost, classification of cost elements – examples from apparel
industry; standard costing, analysis of variance; breakeven analysis, cost volume profit analysis
UNIT II 18
Costing of fabrics; costing of apparel – woven, knits of various styles, accounting of prime costs
and overhead costs, allocation of overheads, cost control; cost sheet preparation
UNIT III 9
Working capital management in garment unit – determination, sources, cost; Budget, types of
budgets, budgeting and control in apparel industry
UNIT IV 9
Detailed project report – elements, preparation for a garment unit
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
OUTCOMES:
At the end of this course, the students will able to
CO1.explain the cost accounting and cost elements
CO2.estimate cost elements involved in fabric and apparel costing
CO3.demonstrate the working capital management
CO4.develop detailed project report preparation
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Pandey I. M., “Financial Management”, Vikas Publishing House Pvt. Ltd., New Delhi, 8th
Edition, 1999.
2. Prasanna Chandra, “Financial Management, Theory and Practice, Tata McGraw-Hill Publishing
Company Ltd, 5th Edition, New Delhi, 2001
REFERENCES:
1. Aswat Damodaran, “Corporate Finance Theory and Practice”, John Wiley & Sons, 2000
2. James C., Van Home., “Financial Management and Policy”, Prentice Hall of India Pvt. Ltd.,
New Delhi, 1980.
3. Thukaram Rao M.E., “Cost and Management Accounting” New Age International, Bangalore,
2004
4. Khan and Jain, “Basic financial Management & Practice”, Tata McGraw Hill, New Delhi, 5th
edition, 2001
167
Course Articulation Matrix:
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
168
CTT355 MANAGEMENT OF TEXTILE EFFLUENTS LTPC
3003
OBJECTIVES
To enable the students to understand the concepts of effluent treatment methods for textile
industry and their management
UNIT I CHARACTERISATION OF EFFLUENTS 9
Characteristics of textile effluents – colour, pH, hardness TSS, TDS, COD, BOD, alkalinity,
estimation of metal ions.
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
170
CTT356 TEXTILE AND APPAREL EXIM MANAGEMENT LTPC
3003
OBJECTIVES:
To give the students an exposure on international market for textile products, regulations with
respect to export and import of textiles
UNIT I 9
International markets for yarns, woven fabrics; international market for cotton, silk, jute, wool and
other fibres; export and import of textiles by India – current status, promotional activities
UNIT II 9
International markets for carpets and home textiles – product types, market potential and statistics,
India - current status and promotional activities, role of export promotional councils
UNIT III 9
International markets for woven piece goods, knitted garments, leather garments; statistics of
international apparel market and trade; export incentives, role of AEPC, CII, FIEO, Textile
Committee
UNIT IV 9
Marketing – strategies, global brand building; logistics & SCM; role of export finances & EXIM
banking, ECGC, Indian council of arbitration, FEMA; impact of foreign trade on Indian economy
UNIT V 9
Exim policy - customs act, acts relating to export/import of textile and apparel; Indian customs
formalities - export documentation for excisable goods, import documentation, clearance of import
goods; concepts - 100% export oriented units, export processing zones, special economic zones;
duty drawback procedure; import/export incentives; licenses; case study
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of this course, the student will be able to,
CO1: Explain the international market for fibre, yarn and woven fabric
CO2: Discuss the international market for carpets and home textiles
CO3: Explain the international market for woven, knitted and leather garments
CO4: Describe the marketing strategies and export finance
CO5: Discuss the Indian EXIM policies and procedure
TEXTBOOKS
1. Kapoor D.C., “Export Management”, Vikas Publishing House Pvt. Ltd., 2009, ISBN:
8125909397 / ISBN: 978-8125909392
2. Govindan N.S., “Indirect Taxes Made Easy”, C. Sitaraman& Co., 2014, ASIN:
B00HYVS32K
REFERENCES
1. Charles W.I. Hill., and Arun Kumar Jain., “International Business”, 10th Edition, Tata
McGraw Hill, 2014, ISBN: 007811277X / ISBN: 978-0078112775.
2. John D. Daniels., and Lee H. Radebaugh., “International Business”, 15th Edition, Pearson
Education Asia, New Delhi, 2014, ISBN: 0133457230 / ISBN: 978-0133457230.
3. Aswathappa K., “International Business”, 6th Edition, Tata McGraw Hill, 2015, ISBN:
933922258X / ISBN: 978-9339222581.
4. Michael R. Czinkota., Ilkka A. Ronkainen., and Michael H.,Moffet, “International
Business”,8th Edition, Wiley, 2010, ISBN: 0470530650 / ISBN: 978-0470530658
5. Aravind V. Phatak., Rabi S. Bhagat., and Roger J. Kashlak., “International Management”, 2
nd Edition, Tata McGraw Hill, 2008, ISBN: 0073210579 / ISBN : 978-0073210575
171
6. OdedShenkar., and YaongLuo., “International Business”,3rd Edition, Routledge, 2014,
ISBN : 0415817137 / ISBN : 978-0415817134
7. Datey V.S., “Indirect Taxes”, 34th Edition, Taxmann Publications, 2015, ISBN: 9350715570
/ISBN: 9789350715574
172
Course Articulation Matrix:
Program
Course Outcome
Statement
Outcomes PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1
1 2 3 4 5 6 PO7 PO8 PO9 PO10 PO11 2 PSO1 PSO2 PSO3
Explain the
international market for
CO1 fibre, yarn and woven 2 1 1 2 1 - - - - 1 - 1 2 1 -
fabric
Discuss the
international market for
CO2 carpets and home 2 1 1 2 1 - - - - 1 - 1 2 1 -
textiles
Explain the
CO3 international market for
woven, knitted and 2 1 1 2 1 - - - - 1 - 1 2 1 -
leather garments
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
173
Technical Textiles
TEXTBOOKS
1. AnandS.C.,“MedicalTextiles”,TextileInstitute,Manchester,2001,ISBN:185573494X.Mukh
opadhyayS.K.andPartridgeJ.F.,“AutomotiveTextiles”,TextileProgress,Vol.29,No1/2,
1999, ISBN: 1870372212.
2. Horrocks A.R. and Anand S.C., “Handbook of Technical Textiles”, The Textile Institute,
Manchester, 2000, ISBN: 1855733854.
174
REFERENCES
1. 1.Adanur S., “Wellington Sears Handbook of Industrial Textiles”,
TechnomicPublishingCo. Inc., 1995, ISBN:1–56676–340–1.
2. Scott.R.A., “Textiles for Protection”, Wood head Publishing Limited, Cambridge,
UK,2005, ISBN1-85573-921-6.
3. Saville.B.P, “Physical Testing of Textiles”, Woodhead Publishing Limited, Cambridge,
UK, 1999, ISBN1-85573-367-6.
4. Long.A.C, “Design and Manufacture of Textile Composities”, Wood head Publishing Ltd,
Cambridge, UK, 2005, ISBN1-85573-744-2.
5. Fung.W,“CoatedandLaminatedTextiles”,WoodheadPublishingLtd.,Cambridge,UK,2002,
ISBN1-85573-576-8.
6. Anand.S.C, Kennedy.J.F, Miraftab.M and Rajendran.S., “Medical Textiles
andBiomaterials for Health Care”, Wood head Publishing Ltd, Cambridge, UK, 2006,
ISBN1- 85573-683-7.
7. Fung.W and Hardcastle, “Textiles in Automotive Engineering”, Wood head
PublishingLtd., Cambridge, UK, 2001, ISBN1-85573-493-1.
8. John.N.W.M,“GeoTextile”,BlackieandSonsLtd.,London,UK.,1987,ISBN0-412-1351-
9. Sarsby R.W., “Geosynthetics in civil engineering”, Wood head
Publishing, Cambridge, U.K., 2006, ISBN:9781855736078.
175
Course Articulation Matrix:
Program
Course Outcome
Statement
Outcomes PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO
PO1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2 PSO3
Discuss the application of textiles
CO1 and composites in automotive 3 2 3 3 2 - - - - - - 1 3 2 3
textiles
Explain the uses of textiles in
CO2 medical and hygiene applications 3 2 3 3 2 - - - - - - 1 3 2 3
Overall CO 3 2 3 3 2 - - - - - - 1 3 2 3
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
176
CTT340 MEDICAL TEXTILES LT P C
3003
OBJECTIVES:
To enable the students, understand the different types of biomaterials and biomedical
application of different textile structures
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
178
CTT339 HOME TEXTILES LTPC
3003
COURSE OBJECTIVES
To enable the students to learn about
Various kinds of materials used as home textiles
Recent developments in home furnishing, floor covering and other home textile products
Finishes and Evaluation required for home textiles.
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 5
Concepts of Home textiles and its market scenario, consumer expectation from home textiles;
fibers and fabrics used - Woven, nonwoven and knits; manufacturing concepts- damask, brocade,
organdie, chiffon, oxford, tapestry
TEXTBOOKS:
1. AlexanderN.G., “Designing Interior Environment”, Mas Court Brace Covanorich,
Newyork, 1972 67
2. DonserkeryK.G., “Interior Decoration in India”, D.B.Taraporeval Sons and Co. Pvt.
Ltd., 1979, ISBN: 0906216338 | ISBN-13: 9780906216330
REFERENCES:
1. Wingate J. F., and Mohler I. B., “Textile Fabrics& Their Selection”, Prentice Hall
Inc., New York, 1984,ISBN: 0139128654 | ISBN-13: 9780139128653
179
2. Subtra Das, “Performance of home textiles”, Woodhead Publishing India Pvt.Ltd.,
2010, ISBN: 0857090070 | ISBN-13: 9780857090072
3. Rowe T., “Interior Textiles Design and Developments”, Woodhead Publishing India
Pvt.Ltd., 2009, ISBN: 1845693515 | ISBN-13: 9781845693510
4. Schindler W. D., and Hauser P. J., “Chemical finishing of textiles”, Woodhead
Publishing, England, 2004, ISBN: 1855739054 | ISBN-13: 9781855739055
180
Course Articulation Matrix:
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respective
181
CTT346 SMART TEXTILES LTPC
3003
OBJECTIVES:
To enable the students, understand the concept and construction of smart fabrics, intelligent
textiles and interactive garments
UNIT I 13
An overview on smart textiles, electrically active polymers materials- application of non-ionic
polymer gel and elastomers for artificial muscles; heat storage and thermo regulated textiles and
clothing, thermally sensitive materials, cross – linked polymers of fibre substrates as
multifunctional and multi-use intelligent material; mechanical properties of fibre Bragg gratings,
optical responses of FBG (Fibre Bragg grating) sensors under deformation; smart textile
composites integrated with optic sensors
UNIT II 9
Adaptive and responsive textile structures, bio-processing for smart textiles and clothing, tailor
made intelligent polymers for biomedical application
UNIT III 9
Smart fabrics – passive, active, very smart; classification of smart materials, concept of wearable
computing, basic structure of fabric used for integrating different electronic sensors
UNIT IV 14
Smart interactive garments for combat training, hospital and patient care; smart garments in sports
and fitness activities; smart garments for children; smart home textiles
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of this course, the student will be able to,
CO1: Discuss the requirement of polymers and their properties used in smart textiles
CO2: Explain the polymers and textiles for biomedical applications
CO3: Explain the smart materials, fabrics and different electronic sensors
CO4: Describe the application of smart textiles
TEXTBOOKS
1. Sanjay Gupta., “Smart Textiles their Production and Marketing Strategies”, NIFT, New Delhi,
2000.
2. William C. Smith., “Smart Textile Coating and Laminates”, Wood Head Publishing Series in
Textiles, UK, 2010, ISBN 978-1-84569-379-4.
REFERENCES
1. Tao X. M., “Smart Fibers, Fabrics and Clothing Fundamentals and Application”, Wood Head
Publishing Ltd., October 2001, ISBN 1 855735466.
2. Mc Cann J. and Bryson D., “Smart Clothes and Wearable Technology”, Wood Head
Publishing Series in Textiles, UK, 2010, ISBN-10: 1845693574
182
Course Articulation Matrix:
Program
Course Outcome
Statement
Outcomes PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO
PO1 2 PO3 4 5 PO6 PO7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2 PSO3
Discuss the requirement of
CO1 polymers and their properties 3 2 2 2 - - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
used in smart textiles
Explain the polymers
CO2 and textiles for 3 2 2 2 - - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
biomedical applications
Explain the smart materials,
CO3 fabrics and different electronic 3 2 2 2 - - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
sensors
Describe the application of smart
CO4 textiles 3 2 2 2 - - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
Overall CO 3 2 2 2 - - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
183
CTT345 PROTECTIVE TEXTILES LTPC
3003
OBJECTIVES:
To enable the students, understand the selection of fibre, yarn, fabric and design of
garments for different protective applications
REFERENCES
1. Chellamani K. P., and Chattopadhyay D., “Yarns and Technical Textiles”, SITRA, 1999.
2. Scott R.A., “Textiles for Protection”, Wood head Publishing Limited, Cambridge, UK,
ISBN :1-85573-921-6, 2005.
3. Saville.B.P., “Physical Testing of Textiles”, Wood head Publishing Limited, Cambridge,
UK, ISBN :1-85573-367-6, 1999.
4. Fan Q., “Chemical Testing of Textiles”, Wood head Publishing Limited, Cambridge, UK,
ISBN :1-85573-917-8, 2005.
184
Course Articulation Matrix:
Program
Course Outcome
Statement
Outcomes PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO
PO1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2 PSO3
Explain the functional requirement
CO1 of fibres, yarns and fabrics for 3 2 2 2 - - - - - - - 1 3 1 2
different protective applications
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
185
CTT335 COATED TEXTILES L TPC
3 00 3
OBJECTIVES:
To enable the students to understand need for coating of textiles, different methods of
coating of textile fabrics
UNIT I MATERIALS 9
Rubber-natural and synthetic, polyvinyl chloride, polyurethanes, acrylic polymers; adhesive
treatment, radiation- cured coatings; materials and trends; textile fibres-spinning, woven fabrics,
knitted fabrics, nonwoven fabrics
UNIT II PROPERTIES 9
Rheological behavior of fluids; rheology of plastisol’s; hydrodynamic analysis of coating; clothing
comfort, impermeable coating, breathable fabrics
UNIT IV PRODUCTS 9
Synthetic leather, architectural textiles, fluid containers, tarpaulins, automotive air bag fabrics,
carpet backing; textile foam laminates for automotive interiors; flocking fabrics for chemical
protection; thermochromic fabrics, temperature adaptable fabrics, camouflage nets metal and
conducting polymer, coated fabrics
UNIT V EVALUATION 9
Test methods for coated fabrics; environmental norms for the chemicals used in coating industry.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of this course, the student will be able to,
CO1: Explain the polymers and fabrics used for coating
CO2: Discuss the property requirements of coated textiles
CO3: Classify methods of coating of textiles
CO4: Elaborate the applications of coated fabrics
CO5: Evaluate of coated fabrics
TEXTBOOKS
1. Fung. W., “Coated and Laminated Textiles”., Wood head Publishing Limited., Cambridge.,
2002., ISBN: 1 85573 576 8
2. Ghosh. S. K., “Functional Coatings”., Wiley-VCH Verlag, GmbH & Co. KGaA, Weinheim,
2006, ISBN:3- 527-31296-X
REFERENCES
1. GuneuAkovali., Diveswar Banerjee., Sen A. K., and Dipak K. Setua., “Advances in polymer
coated textiles”, SmithersRapra, 2012
2. Ashish Kumar Sen., “Coated Textiles: Principles and Application”,
3. Technomic Publication, U.S.A.,2007, ISBN: 1420053450 | ISBN-13: 9781420053456
4. Mary Jo Waters., “Laboratory Methods for Evaluating Protective Clothing System Against
Chemical Agents”, Report no. CRDC-SP 84010, CRDC, Aberdeen Proving Ground, MD,
U.S.A, 1984
186
Course Articulation Matrix:
Program
Course Outcome
Statement
Outcomes PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO
PO1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2 PSO3
Explain the polymers, fibre
CO1 spinning and fabrics used for 3 2 2 2 - - - - - - - 1 3 1 3
coating
Discuss the rheology of coated
CO2 3 2 2 2 - - - - - - - 1 3 1 3
polymers
Classify coating methods of
CO3 3 2 2 2 - - - - - - - 1 3 1 3
textiles
Elaborate the application of coated
CO4 3 2 2 2 - - - - - - - 1 3 1 3
fabrics
Evaluation of coated fabrics
CO5 3 2 2 2 - - - - - - - 1 3 1 3
Overall CO 3 2 2 2 - - - - - - - 1 3 1 3
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
187
Fundamentals of Textile Structures
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Sperling L.H., “Introduction to Physical Polymer Science”, Wiley India Private Limited, 2005,
ISBN: 047170606X | ISBN-13: 9780471706069
2. Campell D., and White J.R., “Polymer characterization, Physical Techniques”,Chapman& Hall,
1989 , ISBN: 0412271605 | ISBN-13: 9780412271601
REFERENCES
1. Gupta V.B., and Kothari V.K., “Man Made Fibre Production”, Chapman and Hall, 1985.
2. Bill Mayer., “Textbooks of Polymer Science”, 3rd ed., Wiley India Private Limited, 2007, ISBN:
8126511109 | ISBN-13: 9788126511105
3. Stamm M., “Polymer Surfaces and Interfaces”, Springer1st Ed., 2010,ISBN: 3642093116 |
ISBN-13: 9783642093111.
188
Course Articulation Matrix:
Program Outcome
Course
Statement PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO
Outcomes PO1 PSO3
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2
189
CTT334 CLOTHING COMFORT LTPC
3003
OBJECTIVES:
To enable the students to learn about the
Important characteristics of the fabric responsible for its comfort properties.
Different phenomena which take place in the fabric related to the comfort properties of the
fabric.
TEXTBOOKS
1. Hassan M. Behery., “Effect of Mechanical and Physical Properties on Fabric Hand”, Wood head
Publishing Ltd.,2005, ISBN: 1855739186 | ISBN-13: 9781855739185
2. Li Y., “The Science of Clothing Comfort”, Textile Progress 31:1-2, Taylor and Francis, UK, 2001,
ISBN: 1870372247 | ISBN-13: 9781870372244
REFERENCES
1. Laing R.M., and Sleivert G.G., “Clothing, Textile and Human Performance” Textile Progress
32:2, The Textile Institute, 2002, ISBN: 1870372514 | ISBN-13: 9781870372510.
2. ApurbaDas.,andAlagirusamy R., “Science in clothing comfort”, Wood head Publishing India Pvt.
Ltd., India, 2010, ISBN: 1845697898 | ISBN-13: 9781845697891
3. Guowen Song., “Improving comfort in clothing”, Wood head Publishing Ltd., UK, 2011, ISBN:
1845695399 | ISBN-13: 9781845695392
4. Ukponmwan J.O., “The Thermal-insulation Properties of Fabrics”, Textile Progress 24:4, 1- 54,
Taylor and Francis, UK, 1993, ISBN: 1870812654 | ISBN-13: 9781870812658
190
Course Articulation Matrix:
Program Outcome
Course
Statement PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO
Outcomes PO1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2 PSO3
Explain the criteria for
CO1 comfort of fabrics. 3 2 2 2 1 - - - - - - 2 3 2 3
Discuss the psychological
CO2 and physiological comfort 3 2 2 2 1 - - - - - - 2 3 2 3
with respect to clothing.
Describe the thermo
physiological comfort
CO3 requirements of human 3 2 2 2 1 - - - - - - 2 3 2 3
and the role of clothing.
Analyse the behaviour of
CO4 different fabric in relation to 3 2 2 2 1 - - - - - - 2 3 2 3
heat and moisture transfer.
Describe the low stress
mechanical properties of
CO5 fabric with respect to 3 2 2 2 1 - - - - - - 2 3 2 3
comfort to the wearer
Overall CO 3 2 2 2 1 - - - - - - 2 3 2 3
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
191
CTT352 TEXTILE REINFORCED COMPOSITES LTPC
3003
OBJECTIVES:
To enable the students to learn about
Reinforcements, matrices used for the composites and techniques for making composites
Manufacture and testing of composites and application of composites
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Fibre reinforced polymers materials, properties; resins - thermoset and thermo plastics, additives
release agents; composite material classification and its properties; reinforcement – matrix
interface wettability
TEXTBOOKS
1. Leonard Hollaway, “Handbook of Polymer Composites for Engineering”, Wood head Publishing
limited, 2007.
2. Long A C, “Design and Manufacture of Textile Composites”, Wood head Publishing limited,
2005
REFERENCES
1. White J R, and De S K, “Short Fiber-Polymer Composites”, Wood head Publishing limited,1996.
2. George Lubin, “Handbook of Fiberglass and Advanced Plastics Composites”, Van No strand
Reinhold Company, New York, 1969.
192
Course Articulation Matrix:
Program Outcome
Course
Statement PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO
Outcomes PO1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2 PSO3
Discuss the basics of
CO1 composites. 3 2 3 1 1 - 1 - - - - 2 3 2 2
Overall CO 3 2 3 1 1 - 1 - - - - 2 3 2 2
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
193
CTT338 HIGH PERFORMANCE FIBRES LTPC
3003
OBJECTIVES:
To enable the students to learn about
• Various high performance fibres which are used as technical textiles
• Production of high performance fibres
TEXTBOOKS
1. Kothari V.K., “Textile Fibres :Development and Innovations”, Progress in Textiles,Vol.2,IAFL
Publications,2000
2. John W. S. Hearle., “High Performance Fibres”, Wood head Publishing Ltd., Cambridge,
England, 2001, ISBN: 084931304X | ISBN-13:9780849313042
REFERENCES
1. Peebles L.H., “Carbon Fibres”, CRC Press, London,1995 Hongu T., and Phillips G.O., “New
Fibres”, 2nd Edition, Wood head Publishing Ltd., England, 1997, ISBN: 185573334X / ISBN:978-
1855733343
194
Course Articulation Matrix:
Program
Course Outcome
Statement
Outcomes PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO
PO1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2 PSO3
Explain the polymer
CO1 preparation, properties and 3 2 2 2 1 - - - - - - 1 3 2 3
application
Elaborate the manufacturing,
CO2 properties and application of 3 2 2 2 1 - - - - - - 1 3 2 3
Carbon fibres
Discuss the manufacturing,
CO3 properties and application of 3 2 2 2 1 - - - - - - 1 3 2 3
glass and ceramic fibres
Explain the chemical and
CO4 3 2 2 2 1 - - - - - - 1 3 2 3
thermal resistance fibres
Discuss the application of
CO5 hollow fibres, bi – component 3 2 2 2 1 - - - - - - 1 3 2 3
and super absorbent fibres
Overall CO 3 2 2 2 1 - - - - - - 1 3 2 3
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
195
CTT331 ADVANCED TESTING OF TEXTILES LTPC
3003
OBJECTIVES:
To enable the students to
To learn about the functional and technical textiles testing.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Horrocks, A. Richard, and Subhash C. Anand, eds. “Handbook of technical textiles”, Elsevier,
2000.
2. Adanur, Sabit. Wellington Sears., “Handbook of industrial textiles”, Routledge, 2017.
3. K. Slater, “Comfort Properties of Textiles”, Textile Progress, Vol. 9, No. 4, 1977.
REFERENCES:
1. B. P. Saville, “Physical Testing of Textiles,” 1999, Woodhead Publishing Ltd., U. K.
2. J. E. Booth, “Principles of Textile Testing” 1961,Heywood Books, London
3. Das, Apurba, and R. Alagirusamy, “Science in clothing comfort, ”Woodhead Publishing India
Pvt Limited, 2010.
4. K. Slater, “The Thermal Behaviour of Textiles”, Textile Progress, Vol. 8, No. 3, 1976.
5. McKenna, Henry A., John WS Hearle, and Nick O'Hear, “Handbook of fibre rope technology,”
Vol. 34. Woodhead publishing, 2004.
196
Course Articulation Matrix:
Course Statement Program
Outcomes Outcome
PO1 PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO1 PO1 PO1 PSO PSO PSO3
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 1 2
CO1 medical textile materials 3 2 2 3 2 - 1 - - - - 1 3 1 2
Thermal transmission, extreme heat
CO2 3 2 2 3 2 - 1 - - - - 1 3 1 2
and cold protective textiles.
geotextiles, automove textiles and
CO3 3 2 2 3 2 - 1 - - - - 1 3 1 2
agro textiles.
reinforced composites,
CO4 electromagnetic shielding textiles, 3 2 2 3 2 - 1 - - - - 1 3 1 2
sports and packing materials.
ballistic, UV, chemical protective
CO5 3 2 2 3 2 - 1 - - - - 1 3 1 2
textiles
Overall CO 3 2 2 3 2 - 1 - - - - 1 3 1 2
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
197
CTT332 ADVANCES IN TEXTILE PRINTING AND FINISHES LTPC
3003
OBJECTIVES
To enable the students to learn the advances in the field of textile printing and finishing
UNIT I SUBLIMATION TRANSFER PRINTING 9
Mechanism of sublimation transfer printing; selection of the paper; Printing methods; dyes and
inks; Transfer prints on both man-made fibres and natural fibres; Machineries
198
Course Articulation Matrix:
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
199
GE3751 PRINCIPLES OF MANAGEMENT L T P C
3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
Sketch the Evolution of Management.
Extract the functions and principles of management.
Learn the application of the principles in an organization.
Study the various HR related activities.
Analyze the position of self and company goals towards business.
UNIT II PLANNING 9
Nature and purpose of planning – Planning process – Types of planning – Objectives – Setting
objectives – Policies – Planning premises – Strategic Management – Planning Tools and
Techniques – Decision making steps and process.
UNIT IV DIRECTING 9
Foundations of individual and group behaviour– Motivation – Motivation theories – Motivational
techniques – Job satisfaction – Job enrichment – Leadership – types and theories of leadership
– Communication – Process of communication – Barrier in communication – Effective
communication – Communication and IT.
UNIT V CONTROLLING 9
System and process of controlling – Budgetary and non - Budgetary control techniques – Use of
computers and IT in Management control – Productivity problems and management – Control
and performance – Direct and preventive control – Reporting.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1: Upon completion of the course, students will be able to have clear understanding of
managerial functions like planning, organizing, staffing, leading & controlling.
CO2: Have same basic knowledge on international aspect of management.
CO3: Ability to understand management concept of organizing.
CO4: Ability to understand management concept of directing.
CO5: Ability to understand management concept of controlling.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Harold Koontz and Heinz Weihrich “Essentials of management” Tata McGraw Hill,1998.
2. Stephen P. Robbins and Mary Coulter, “ Management”, Prentice Hall (India)Pvt. Ltd.,
10th Edition, 2009.
200
REFERENCES:
1. Robert Kreitner and MamataMohapatra, “ Management”, Biztantra, 2008.
2. Stephen A. Robbins and David A. Decenzo and Mary Coulter, “Fundamentals of
Management” Pearson Education, 7th Edition, 2011.
3. Tripathy PC and Reddy PN, “Principles of Management”, Tata Mcgraw Hill, 1999.
PO’s PSO’s
CO’s 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 3 - - - 1 - - - - - - 2 1 1
2 - 1 1 - - - - - - - - - 2 1 -
3 1 - 2 - - 1 - 2 - 1 1 - - 2
4 - 1 1 1 2 - - 1 2 - - - 1 1 1
5 1 - - 1 1 - - - 3 - 1 1 - 1
AVg. 1.66 1 1 1.5 1.5 1 1 1 2 3 1 1 1.5 1 1.25
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Introduction - Need for quality - Evolution of quality - Definition of quality - Dimensions of product
and service quality –Definition of TQM-- Basic concepts of TQM - Gurus of TQM (Brief
introduction) -- TQM Framework- Barriers to TQM –Benefits of TQM.
TEXT BOOK:
1. Dale H.Besterfiled, Carol B.Michna,Glen H. Bester field,MaryB.Sacre,
HemantUrdhwareshe and RashmiUrdhwareshe, “Total Quality Management”, Pearson
Education Asia, RevisedThird Edition, Indian Reprint, Sixth Impression,2013.
REFERENCES:
1 Joel.E. Ross, “Total Quality Management – Text and Cases”,Routledge.,2017.
2. Kiran.D.R, “Total Quality Management: Key concepts and case studies, Butterworth –
Heinemann Ltd, 2016.
3. Oakland, J.S. “TQM – Text with Cases”, Butterworth – Heinemann Ltd., Oxford, Third
Edition,2003.
4. Suganthi,L and Anand Samuel, “Total Quality Management”, Prentice Hall (India) Pvt.
Ltd.,2006 .
202
UNIT I DEMAND & SUPPLY ANALYSIS 9
Managerial Economics - Relationship with other disciplines - Firms: Types, objectives
and goals - Managerial decisions - Decision analysis.Demand - Types of demand - Determinants
of demand - Demand function – Demand elasticity - Demand forecasting - Supply - Determinants
of supply - Supply function -Supply elasticity.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Decenzo and Robbins, "Human Resource Management", 8th Edition, Wiley, 2007.
2. John Bernardin. H., "Human Resource Management – An Experimental Approach", 5th Edition,
Tata McGraw Hill, 2013, New Delhi.
REFERENCES:
1. Luis R,. Gomez-Mejia, DavidB. Balkin and Robert L. Cardy, “Managing Human Resources", 7th
Edition, PHI, 2012.
1. Dessler, "Human Resource Management", Pearson Education Limited, 2007.
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Introduction: An Introduction to Knowledge Management - The foundations of
knowledge management- including cultural issues- technology applications organizational concepts
and processes- management aspects- and decision support systems. The Evolution of Knowledge
management: From Information Management to Knowledge Management - Key Challenges Facing
the Evolution of Knowledge Management - Ethics for Knowledge Management.
TEXT BOOK:
1. Srikantaiah, T.K., Koenig, M., “Knowledge Management for the Information Professional”
Information Today, Inc., 2000.
REFERENCE:
1. Nonaka, I., Takeuchi, H., “The Knowledge-Creating Company: How Japanese
Companies Create the Dynamics of Innovation”, Oxford University Press, 1995.
206
UNIT – III FUNCTIONS OF MANAGEMENT - II 9
Directing (Leading): Leadership Traits; Style; Morale; Managerial Grids (Blake-Mounton, Reddin)
– Communication: Purpose; Model; Barriers – Controlling: Process; Types; Levels; Guidelines;
Audit (External, Internal, Merits); Preventive Control – Decision Making: Elements; Characteristics;
Nature; Process; Classifications.
TEXTBOOKS:
1 M. Govindarajan and S. Natarajan, “Principles of Management”, Prentice Hall of India,
New Delhi, 2009.
2 Koontz. H. and Weihrich. H., “Essentials of Management: An International Perspective”, 8th
Edition, Tata McGrawhill, New Delhi, 2010.
REFERENCES:
1 Joseph J, Massie, “Essentials of Management”, 4th Edition, Pearson Education, 1987.
2 Saxena, P. K., “Principles of Management: A Modern Approach”, Global India
Publications, 2009.
3 S.Chandran, “Organizational Behaviours”, Vikas Publishing House Pvt. Ltd., 1994.
4 Richard L. Daft, “Organization Theory and Design”, South Western College Publishing, 11th
Edition, 2012.
5 S. TrevisCerto, “Modern Management Concepts and Skills”, Pearson Education, 2018.
207
MAPPING OF COS AND POS:
PO PSO
CO
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 1 1 1 1 1 3 2 3 2 3 1 3 1 1 1
2 1 1 1 1 1 3 2 3 2 3 1 3 1 1 1
3 1 1 1 1 1 3 2 3 2 3 1 3 1 1 1
4 1 1 1 1 1 3 2 3 2 3 1 3 1 1 1
5 1 1 1 1 1 3 2 3 2 3 1 3 1 1 1
208
MANDATORY COURSES I
UNIT I CONCEPTS
Sex vs. Gender, masculinity, femininity, socialization, patriarchy, public/ private, essentialism,
binaryism, power, hegemony, hierarchy, stereotype, gender roles, gender relation, deconstruction,
resistance, sexual division of labour.
1. Relevance of literature
a) Enhances Reading, thinking, discussing and writing skills.
b) Develops finer sensibility for better human relationship.
c) Increases understanding of the problem of humanity without bias.
d) Providing space to reconcile and get a cathartic effect.
2. Elements of fiction
a) Fiction, fact and literary truth.
b) Fictional modes and patterns.
c) Plot character and perspective.
3. Elements of poetry
209
a) Emotions and imaginations.
b) Figurative language.
c) (Simile, metaphor, conceit, symbol, pun and irony).
d) Personification and animation.
e) Rhetoric and trend.
4. Elements of drama
a) Drama as representational art.
b) Content mode and elements.
c) Theatrical performance.
d) Drama as narration, mediation and persuasion.
e) Features of tragedy, comedy and satire.
3. READINGS:
1. An Introduction to the Study of English Literature, W.H. Hudson, Atlantic, 2007.
2. An Introduction to Literary Studies, Mario Klarer, Routledge, 2013.
3. The Experience of Poetry, Graham Mode, Open college of Arts with Open Unv Press,
1991.
4. The Elements of Fiction: A Survey, Ulf Wolf (ed), Wolfstuff, 2114.
5. The Elements of Drama, J.L.Styan, Literary Licensing, 2011.
3.1 Textbook:
3.2 *Reference Books:: To be decided by the teacher and student, on the basis of individual
student so as to enable him or her to write the term paper.
4. OTHER SESSION:
4.1*Tutorials:
4.2*Laboratory:
4.3*Project: The students will write a term paper to show their understanding of a particular
piece of literature
5.*ASSESSMENT:
5.1HA:
5.2Quizzes-HA:
5.3Periodical Examination: one
5.4Project/Lab: one (under the guidance of the teachers the students will take a volume of
poetry, fiction or drama and write a term paper to show their understanding of it in a given
context; sociological, psychological, historical, autobiographical etc.
5.5Final Exam:
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
OUTCOME OF THE COURSE:
Students will be able to understand the relevance of literature in human life and appreciate
its aspects in developing finer sensibilities.
210
MX3083 FILM APPRECIATION LTPC
3 000
In this course on film appreciation, the students will be introduced broadly to the development of
film as an art and entertainment form. It will also discuss the language of cinema as it evolved over
a century. The students will be taught as to how to read a film and appreciate the various nuances
of a film as a text. The students will be guided to study film joyfully.
Theme - A: The Component of Films
A-1: The material and equipment
A-2: The story, screenplay and script
A-3: The actors, crew members, and the director
A-4: The process of film making… structure of a film
Theme - B: Evolution of Film Language
B-1: Film language, form, movement etc.
B-2: Early cinema… silent film (Particularly French)
B-3: The emergence of feature films: Birth of a Nation
B-4: Talkies
Theme - C: Film Theories and Criticism/Appreciation
C-1: Realist theory; Auteurists
C-2: Psychoanalytic, Ideological, Feminists
C-3: How to read films?
C-4: Film Criticism / Appreciation
Theme – D: Development of Films
D-1: Representative Soviet films
D-2: Representative Japanese films
D-3: Representative Italian films
D-4: Representative Hollywood film and the studio system
Theme - E: Indian Films
E-1: The early era
E-2: The important films made by the directors
E-3: The regional films
E-4: The documentaries in India
READING:
A Reader containing important articles on films will be prepared and given to the students. The
students must read them and present in the class and have discussion on these.
COURSE OUTCOME:
CO1: To impart knowledge on the concepts of Disaster, Vulnerability and Disaster Risk reduction
(DRR)
CO2: To enhance understanding on Hazards, Vulnerability and Disaster Risk Assessment
prevention and risk reduction
CO3: To develop disaster response skills by adopting relevant tools and technology
212
CO4: Enhance awareness of institutional processes for Disaster response in the country and
CO5: Develop rudimentary ability to respond to their surroundings with potential Disaster response
in areas where they live, with due sensitivity
PO’s PSO’s
CO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 3 3 2 3 - - 2 2 - - 2 - 2 - 1
2 3 3 3 3 - - 2 1 - - 2 - 2 - 1
3 3 3 3 3 - - 2 2 - - - - 2 - 1
4 3 3 2 3 - - 2 1 - - 2 - 2 - 1
5 3 3 2 3 - - 2 2 - - 2 - 3 - 1
AVG 3 3 3 3 - - 2 2 - - 2 - 2 - 1
MANDATORY COURSES II
Present health status - The life expectancy-present status - mortality rate - dreadful diseases -
Non-communicable diseases (NCDs) the leading cause of death - 60% - heart disease – cancer –
diabetes - chronic pulmonary diseases - risk factors – tobacco – alcohol - unhealthy diet - lack of
physical activities.
Causes of the above diseases / disorders - Importance of prevention of illness - Takes care
of health - Improves quality of life - Reduces absenteeism - Increase satisfaction - Saves time
Simple lifestyle modifications to maintain health - Healthy Eating habits (Balanced diet
according to age) Physical Activities (Stretching exercise, aerobics, resisting exercise) -
Maintaining BMI-Importance and actions to be taken
213
UNIT II DIET 4+6
Role of diet in maintaining health - energy one needs to keep active throughout the day -
nutrients one needs for growth and repair - helps one to stay strong and healthy - helps to prevent
diet-related illness, such as some cancers - keeps active and - helps one to maintain a healthy
weight - helps to reduce risk of developing lifestyle disorders like diabetes – arthritis –
hypertension – PCOD – infertility – ADHD – sleeplessness -helps to reduce the risk of heart
diseases - keeps the teeth and bones strong.
Balanced Diet and its 7 Components - Carbohydrates – Proteins – Fats – Vitamins – Minerals -
Fibre and Water.
Food additives and their merits & demerits - Effects of food additives - Types of food additives -
Food additives and processed foods - Food additives and their reactions
UNIT III ROLE OF AYURVEDA & SIDDHA SYSTEMS IN MAINTAINING HEALTH 4+4
AYUSH systems and their role in maintaining health - preventive aspect of AYUSH - AYUSH
as a soft therapy.
Secrets of traditional healthy living - Traditional Diet and Nutrition - Regimen of Personal and
Social Hygiene - Daily routine (Dinacharya) - Seasonal regimens (Ritucharya) - basic sanitation
and healthy living environment - Sadvritta (good conduct) - for conducive social life.
Principles of Siddha & Ayurveda systems - Macrocosm and Microcosm theory -
Pancheekarana Theory / (Five Element Theory) 96 fundamental Principles - Uyir Thathukkal (Tri-
Dosha Theory) - Udal Thathukkal
Prevention of illness with our traditional system of medicine
Primary Prevention - To decrease the number of new cases of a disorder or illness - Health
promotion/education, and - Specific protective measures - Secondary Prevention - To lower the
rate of established cases of a disorder or illness in the population (prevalence) - Tertiary
Prevention - To decrease the amount of disability associated with an existing disorder.
UNIT IV MENTAL WELLNESS 3+4
Emotional health - Definition and types - Three key elements: the subjective experience - the
physiological response - the behavioral response - Importance of maintaining emotional health -
Role of emotions in daily life -Short term and long term effects of emotional disturbances - Leading
a healthy life with emotions - Practices for emotional health - Recognize how thoughts influence
emotions - Cultivate positive thoughts - Practice self-compassion - Expressing a full range of
emotions.
Stress management - Stress definition - Stress in daily life - How stress affects one’s life -
Identifying the cause of stress - Symptoms of stress - Managing stress (habits, tools, training,
professional help) - Complications of stress mismanagement.
Sleep - Sleep and its importance for mental wellness - Sleep and digestion.
Immunity - Types and importance - Ways to develop immunity
UNIT V YOGA 2+12
Definition and importance of yoga - Types of yoga - How to Choose the Right Kind for
individuals according to their age - The Eight Limbs of Yoga - Simple yogasanas for cure and
prevention of health disorders - What yoga can bring to our life.
214
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Nutrition and Dietetics - Ashley Martin, Published by White Word Publications,
New York, NY 10001, USA
2. Yoga for Beginners_ 35 Simple Yoga Poses to Calm Your Mind and Strengthen Your
Body,
by Cory Martin, Copyright © 2015 by Althea Press, Berkeley, California
REFERENCES:
1. WHAT WE KNOW ABOUT EMOTIONAL INTELLIGENCE How It Affects Learning, Work,
Relationships, and Our Mental Health, by Moshe Zeidner, Gerald Matthews, and Richard D.
Roberts A Bradford Book, The MIT Press, Cambridge, Massachusetts, London, England
2. The Mindful Self-Compassion Workbook, Kristin Neff, Ph.D Christopher Germer, Ph.D,
Published by The Guilford Press A Division of Guilford Publications, Inc.370 Seventh Avenue,
Suite 1200, New York, NY 10001
1. https://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/pmc/articles/PMC4799645/
2. Simple lifestyle modifications to maintain health
https://www.niddk.nih.gov/health-information/diet-nutrition/changing-habits-better-
health#:~:text=Make%20your%20new%20healthy%20habit,t%20have%20time%20
to%20cook.
3. Read more: https://www.legit.ng/1163909-classes-food-examples-functions.html
4. https://www.yaclass.in/p/science-state-board/class-9/nutrition-and-health-5926
5. Benefits of healthy eating https://www.cdc.gov/nutrition/resources-
publications/benefits-of-healthy-eating.html
6. Food additives
https://www.betterhealth.vic.gov.au/health/conditionsandtreatments/food-additives
7. BMI https://www.hsph.harvard.edu/nutritionsource/healthy-weight/
https://www.who.int/europe/news-room/fact-sheets/item/a-healthy-lifestyle---who-
recommendations
8. Yoga https://www.healthifyme.com/blog/types-of-yoga/
https://yogamedicine.com/guide-types-yoga-styles/
Ayurveda : https://vikaspedia.in/health/ayush/ayurveda-1/concept-of-healthy-living-
in-ayurveda
9. Siddha : http://www.tkdl.res.in/tkdl/langdefault/Siddha/Sid_Siddha_Concepts.asp
10. CAM : https://www.hindawi.com/journals/ecam/2013/376327/
11. Preventive herbs : https://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/pmc/articles/PMC3847409/
COURSE OUTCOMES:
After completing the course, the students will be able to:
Learn the importance of different components of health
Gain confidence to lead a healthy life
Learn new techniques to prevent lifestyle health disorders
Understand the importance of diet and workouts in maintaining health
215
MX3086 HISTORY OF SCIENCE AND TECHNOLOGY IN INDIA LT PC
3 0 00
UNIT-I CONCEPTS AND PERSPECTIVES
Meaning of History
Objectivity, Determinism, Relativism, Causation, Generalization in History; Moral judgment in
history
Extent of subjectivity, contrast with physical sciences, interpretation and speculation, causation
verses evidence, concept of historical inevitability, Historical Positivism.
Science and Technology-Meaning, Scope and Importance, Interaction of science, technology &
society, Sources of history on science and technology in India.
OBJECTIVES:
This course will begin with a short overview of human needs and desires and how different
political-economic systems try to fullfill them. In the process, we will end with a critique of
different systems and their implementations in the past, with possible future directions.
COURSE TOPICS:
Considerations for humane society, holistic thought, human being’s desires, harmony in self,
harmony in relationships, society, and nature, societal systems. (9 lectures, 1 hour each)
216
(Refs: A Nagaraj, M K Gandhi, JC Kumarappa)
Fascism and totalitarianism. World war I and II. Cold war. (2 lectures)
Communism – Mode of production, theory of labour, surplus value, class struggle, dialectical
materialism, historical materialism, Russian and Chinese models.
Welfare state. Relation with human desires. Empowered human beings, satisfaction. (3 lectures)
Gandhian thought. Swaraj, Decentralized economy & polity, Community. Control over one’s lives.
Relationship with nature. (6 lectures)
Conclusion (2 lectures)
Total lectures: 39
Reference Books: Authors mentioned along with topics above. Detailed reading list will be
provided.
GRADING:
Mid sems 30
End sem 20
Home Assign 10
Term paper 40
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
OUTCOME:
The students will get an understanding of how societies are shaped by philosophy, political
and economic system, how they relate to fulfilling human goals & desires with some case
studies of how different attempts have been made in the past and how they have fared.
217
MX3088 STATE, NATION BUILDING AND POLITICS IN INDIA LT PC
3 0 00
OBJECTIVE:
The objective of the course is to provide an understanding of the state, how it works through its
main organs, primacy of politics and political process, the concept of sovereignty and its changing
contours in a globalized world. In the light of this, an attempt will be made to acquaint the students
with the main development and legacies of national movement and constitutional development in
India, reasons for adopting a Parliamentary-federal system, the broad philosophy of the
Constitution of India and the changing nature of Indian Political System. Challenges/ problems and
issues concerning national integration and nation-building will also be discussed in the
contemporary context with the aim of developing a future vision for a better India.
TOPICS:
Understanding the need and role of State and politics.
SUGGESTED READING:
i. Sunil Khilnani, The Idea of India. Penguin India Ltd., New Delhi.
ii. Madhav Khosla, The Indian Constitution, Oxford University Press. New Delhi, 2012.
iii. Brij Kishore Sharma, Introduction to the Indian Constitution, PHI, New Delhi, latest edition.
iv. Sumantra Bose, Transforming India: Challenges to the World’s Largest Democracy,
Picador India, 2013.
v. Atul Kohli, Democracy and Discontent: India’s Growing Crisis of Governability, Cambridge
University Press, Cambridge, U. K., 1991.
vi. M. P. Singh and Rekha Saxena, Indian Politics: Contemporary Issues and Concerns, PHI,
New Delhi, 2008, latest edition.
218
vii. Rajni Kothari, Rethinking Democracy, Orient Longman, New Delhi, 2005.
TEXTBOOKS
1. R.K. Jain and Prof. Sunil S. Rao Industrial Safety, Health and Environment Management
Systems KHANNA PUBLISHER
2. L. M. Deshmukh Industrial Safety Management: Hazard Identification and Risk Control
McGraw-Hill Education
219
REFERENCES
1. Frank Lees (2012) ‘Lees’ Loss Prevention in Process Industries.Butterworth-Heinemann
publications, UK, 4th Edition.
2. John Ridley & John Channing (2008)Safety at Work: Routledge, 7th Edition.
3. Dan Petersen (2003) Techniques of Safety Management: A System Approach.
4. Alan Waring.(1996).Safety management system: Chapman &Hall,England
5. Society of Safety Engineers, USA
ONLINE RESOURCES
ISO 45001:2018 occupational health and safety (OH&S) International Organization for
Standardization https://www.iso.org/standard/63787.html
Indian Standard code of practice on occupational safety and health audit
https://law.resource.org/pub/in/bis/S02/is.14489.1998.pdf
Indian Standard code of practice on Hazard Identification and Risk Analysis IS 15656:2006
https://law.resource.org/pub/in/bis/S02/is.15656.2006.pdf
Program Outcome
Course
Statement PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PS
Outcomes
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 O1 O2 O3
Understand the
CO1 basic concept of 3 3 3 1 1 3 2 2 3 3 1 3 3 3 3
safety.
Obtain knowledge
CO2 of Statutory
2 3 2 2 1 3 2 3 3 2 1 3 3 3 3
Regulations and
standards.
Know about the
CO3 safety Activities of 2 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 3 2 1 2 3 3 3
the Working Place.
Analyze on the
CO4 impact of
Occupational 3 3 3 2 2 3 2 2 3 2 1 3 3 3 3
Exposures and
their Remedies
Obtain knowledge
CO5 of Risk
3 2 3 2 2 3 2 2 3 2 2 3 3 3 3
Assessment
Techniques.
Industrial safety 3 3 3 2 1 3 2 2 3 2 1 3 3 3 3
220
OPEN ELECTIVE I AND II
221
8. Write a program to implement the naïve Bayesian classifier.
Unsupervised learning
9. Implementing neural network using self-organizing maps
10. Implementing k-Means algorithm to cluster a set of data.
11. Implementing hierarchical clustering algorithm.
Note:
Installation of gnu-prolog, Study of Prolog (gnu-prolog).
The programs can be implemented in using C++/JAVA/ Python or appropriate tools can be
used by designing good user interface
Data sets can be taken from standard repositories
(https://archive.ics.uci.edu/ml/datasets.html) or constructed by the students.
OUTCOMES:
CO1: Understand the foundations of AI and the structure of Intelligent Agents
CO2: Use appropriate search algorithms for any AI problem
CO3: Study of learning methods
CO4: Solving problem using Supervised learning
CO5: Solving problem using Unsupervised learning
TOTAL PERIODS: 60
TEXT BOOK
1. S. Russell and P. Norvig, “Artificial Intelligence: A Modern Approach”, Prentice Hall, Fourth
Edition, 2021
2. S.N.Sivanandam and S.N.Deepa, Principles of soft computing-Wiley India.3 rd ed,
REFERENCES
1. Machine Learning. Tom Mitchell. First Edition, McGraw- Hill, 1997.
2. I. Bratko, “Prolog: Programming for Artificial Intelligence‖, Fourth edition, Addison-Wesley
Educational Publishers Inc., 2011.
3. C. Muller & Sarah Alpaydin, Ethem. Introduction to machine learning. MIT press, 2020.
222
UNIT III PROTOCOLS AND TECHNOLOGIES BEHIND IOT 6
IOT Protocols - IPv6, 6LoWPAN, MQTT, CoAP - RFID, Wireless Sensor Networks, BigData
Analytics, Cloud Computing, Embedded Systems.
OUTCOMES:
CO 1:Explain the concept of IoT.
CO 2:Understand the communication models and various protocols for IoT.
CO 3:Design portable IoT using Arduino/Raspberry Pi /open platform
CO 4:Apply data analytics and use cloud offerings related to IoT.
CO 5:Analyze applications of IoT in real time scenario.
TOTAL PERIODS:60
TEXTBOOKS
1. Robert Barton, Patrick Grossetete, David Hanes, Jerome Henry, Gonzalo Salgueiro, “IoT
Fundamentals: Networking Technologies, Protocols, and Use Cases for the Internet of Things”,
CISCO Press, 2017
2. Samuel Greengard, The Internet of Things, The MIT Press, 2015
REFERENCES
1. Perry Lea, “Internet of things for architects”, Packt, 2018
2. Olivier Hersent, David Boswarthick, Omar Elloumi , “The Internet of Things – Key
applications and Protocols”, Wiley, 2012
3. IOT (Internet of Things) Programming: A Simple and Fast Way of Learning, IOT Kindle
Edition.
4. Dieter Uckelmann, Mark Harrison, Michahelles, Florian (Eds), “Architecting the Internet of
Things”, Springer, 2011.
5. ArshdeepBahga, Vijay Madisetti, “Internet of Things – A hands-on approach”, Universities
Press, 2015
6. https://www.arduino.cc/
https://www.ibm.com/smarterplanet/us/en/?ca=v_smarterplanet
223
OCS353 DATA SCIENCE FUNDAMENTALS LTPC
2 023
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
● Familiarize students with the data science process.
● Understand the data manipulation functions in Numpy and Pandas.
● Explore different types of machine learning approaches.
● Understand and practice visualization techniques using tools.
● Learn to handle large volumes of data with case studies.
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 6
Data Science: Benefits and uses – facets of data - Data Science Process: Overview – Defining
research goals – Retrieving data – data preparation - Exploratory Data analysis – build the model
– presenting findings and building applications - Data Mining - Data Warehousing – Basic
statistical descriptions of Data
LAB EXERCISES
1. Download, install and explore the features of Python for data analytics.
2. Working with Numpy arrays
3. Working with Pandas data frames
4. Basic plots using Matplotlib
5. Statistical and Probability measures
a) Frequency distributions
b) Mean, Mode, Standard Deviation
c) Variability
d) Normal curves
e) Correlation and scatter plots
f) Correlation coefficient
g) Regression
224
6. Use the standard benchmark data set for performing the following:
a) Univariate Analysis: Frequency, Mean, Median, Mode, Variance, Standard Deviation,
Skewness and Kurtosis.
b) Bivariate Analysis: Linear and logistic regression modelling.
7. Apply supervised learning algorithms and unsupervised learning algorithms on any data set.
8. Apply and explore various plotting functions on any data set.
Note: Example data sets like: UCI, Iris, Pima Indians Diabetes etc.
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of this course, the students will be able to:
CO1: Gain knowledge on data science process.
CO2: Perform data manipulation functions using Numpy and Pandas.
CO3 Understand different types of machine learning approaches.
CO4: Perform data visualization using tools.
CO5: Handle large volumes of data in practical scenarios.
TOTAL PERIODS:60
TEXT BOOKS
1. David Cielen, Arno D. B. Meysman, and Mohamed Ali, “Introducing Data Science”,
Manning Publications, 2016.
2. Jake VanderPlas, “Python Data Science Handbook”, O’Reilly, 2016.
REFERENCES
1. Robert S. Witte and John S. Witte, “Statistics”, Eleventh Edition, Wiley Publications, 2017.
2. Allen B. Downey, “Think Stats: Exploratory Data Analysis in Python”, Green Tea
Press,2014.
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 7
Introduction to Virtual Reality and Augmented Reality – Definition – Introduction to Trajectories and
Hybrid Space-Three I’s of Virtual Reality – Virtual Reality Vs 3D Computer Graphics – Benefits of
Virtual Reality – Components of VR System – Introduction to AR-AR Technologies-Input Devices –
3D Position Trackers – Types of Trackers – Navigation and Manipulation Interfaces – Gesture
Interfaces – Types of Gesture Input Devices – Output Devices – Graphics Display – Human Visual
System – Personal Graphics Displays – Large Volume Displays – Sound Displays – Human
Auditory System.
UNIT II VR MODELING 6
Modeling – Geometric Modeling – Virtual Object Shape – Object Visual Appearance – Kinematics
Modeling – Transformation Matrices – Object Position – Transformation Invariants –Object
Hierarchies – Viewing the 3D World – Physical Modeling – Collision Detection – Surface
225
Deformation – Force Computation – Force Smoothing and Mapping – Behavior Modeling – Model
Management.
UNIT IV APPLICATIONS 6
Human Factors in VR – Methodology and Terminology – VR Health and Safety Issues – VR and
Society-Medical Applications of VR – Education, Arts and Entertainment – Military VR Applications
– Emerging Applications of VR – VR Applications in Manufacturing – Applications of VR in
Robotics – Information Visualization – VR in Business – VR in Entertainment – VR in Education.
TEXTBOOKS:
1. Charles Palmer, John Williamson, “Virtual Reality Blueprints: Create compelling VR
experiences for mobile”, Packt Publisher, 2018
2. Dieter Schmalstieg, Tobias Hollerer, “Augmented Reality: Principles & Practice”, Addison
Wesley, 2016
3. John Vince, “Introduction to Virtual Reality”, Springer-Verlag, 2004.
4. William R. Sherman, Alan B. Craig: Understanding Virtual Reality – Interface, Application,
Design”, Morgan Kaufmann, 2003
226
CO’s – PO’s & PSO’s MAPPING
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 3 2 2 - 3 - - - 2 2 1 2 2 1 2
2 3 2 2 1 3 - - - 3 2 2 3 3 1 2
3 3 3 2 2 3 - - - 3 2 1 2 3 2 2
4 3 3 3 2 3 - - - 3 2 2 3 3 2 2
5 3 3 3 3 3 - - - 3 3 3 3 3 3 3
AVg. 3.00 2.60 2.40 2.00 3.00 - - - 2.80 2.20 1.80 2.60 2.80 1.80 2.20
Objectives:
To train the students in the language components essential to face competitive
examinations both at the national (UPSC, Banking, Railway, Defence) and the
international level (GRE, TOEFL, IELTS).
To enhance an awareness of the specific patterns in language testing and the
respective skills to tackle verbal reasoning and verbal ability tests.
To inculcate effective practices in language-learning in order to improve accuracy in
usage of grammar and coherence in writing.
To improve students’ confidence to express their ideas and opinions in formal contexts
To create awareness of accuracy and precision in communication
UNIT I 9
Orientation on different formats of competitive exams - Vocabulary – Verbal ability – Verbal
reasoning - Exploring the world of words – Essential words – Meaning and their usage –
Synonyms-antonyms – Word substitution – Word analogy – Idioms and phrases – Commonly
confused words – Spellings – Word expansion – New words in use.
UNIT II 9
Grammar – Sentence improvement –Sentence completion – Rearranging phrases into sentences
– Error identification –Tenses – Prepositions – Adjectives – Adverbs – Subject-verb agreement –
Voice – Reported speech – Articles – Clauses – Speech patterns.
UNIT III 9
Reading - Specific information and detail – Identifying main and supporting ideas – Speed reading
techniques – Improving global reading skills – Linking ideas – Summarising – Understanding
argument – Identifying opinion/attitude and making inferences - Critical reading.
UNIT IV 9
227
Writing – Pre-writing techniques – Mindmap - Describing pictures and facts - Paragraph structure –
organising points – Rhetoric writing – Improving an answer – Drafting, writing and developing an
argument – Focus on cohesion – Using cohesive devices –Analytic writing – Structure and types
of essay – Mind maps – Structure of drafts, letters, memos, emails – Statements of Purpose –
Structure, Content and Style.
UNIT V 9
Listening and Speaking – Contextual listening – Listening to instructions – Listening for specific
information – Identifying detail, main ideas – Following signpost words – Stress, rhythm and
intonation - Speaking to respond and elicit ideas – Guided speaking – Opening phrases –
Interactive communication – Dysfluency -Sentence stress – Speaking on a topic – Giving opinions
– Giving an oral presentation – Telling a story or a personal anecdote – Talking about oneself -
Utterance – Speech acts- Brainstorming ideas – Group discussion.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
Learning Outcomes:
At the end of the course, learners will be able
expand their vocabulary and gain practical techniques to read and comprehend a wide
range of texts with the emphasis required
identify errors with precision and write with clarity and coherence
understand the importance of task fulfilment and the usage of task-appropriate
vocabulary
communicate effectively in group discussions, presentations and interviews
write topic based essays with precision and accuracy
Note: The average value of this course to be used for program articulation matrix.
Teaching Methods:
Instructional methods will involve discussions, taking mock tests on various question papers –
Objective, multiple-choice and descriptive. Peer evaluation, self-check on improvement and peer
feedback - Practice sessions on speaking assessments, interview and discussion – Using
multimedia.
Evaluative Pattern:
Internal Tests – 50%
End Semester Exam - 50%
TEXTBOOKS:
1. R.P.Bhatnagar - General English for Competitive Examinations. Macmillan India
Limited, 2009.
REFERENCEBOOKS:
228
1. Educational Testing Service - The Official Guide to the GRE Revised General Test,
Tata McGraw Hill, 2010.
2. The Official Guide to the TOEFL Test, Tata McGraw Hill, 2010.
3. R Rajagopalan- General English for Competitive Examinations, McGraw Hill
Education (India) Private Limited, 2008.
Websites
http://www.examenglish.com/, http://www.ets.org/ , http://www.bankxams.com/
http://civilservicesmentor.com/, http://www.educationobserver.com
http://www.cambridgeenglish.org/in/
229
OCE353 LEAN CONCEPTS, TOOLS AND PRACTICES LT P C
3 0 0 3
OBJECTIVE:
To impart knowledge about the basics of lean principles, tools and techniques, and
implementation in the construction industry.
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Introduction and overview of the construction project management - Review of Project
Management & Productivity Measurement Systems - Productivity in Construction - Daily Progress
Report-The state of the industry with respect to its management practices -construction project
phases - The problems with current construction management techniques.
REFERENCES:
1. Corfe, C. and Clip, B., Implementing lean in construction: Lean and the sustainability agenda,
CIRIA, 2013.
2. Shang Gao and Sui Pheng Low, Lean Construction Management: The Toyota Way, Springer,
2014.
3. Dave, B., Koskela, L., Kiviniemi, A., Owen, R., andTzortzopoulos, P.,Implementing lean in
construction: Lean construction and BIM, CIRIA, 2013.
4. Ballard, G., Tommelein, I., Koskela, L. and Howell, G., Lean construction tools and
techniques, 2002.
5. Salem, O., Solomon, J., Genaidy, A. and Luegring, M., Site implementation and Assessment
of Lean Construction Techniques, Lean Construction Journal, 2005
230
OMG352 NGOS AND SUSTAINABLE DEVELOPMENT L T P C
3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES
. to understand the importance of sustainable development
to acquire a reasonable knowledge on the legal frameworks pertaining to pollution control and
environmental management
to comprehend the role of NGOs in attaining sustainable development
REFERENCE BOOKS
1. Kulsange, S and Kamble, R. (2019). Environmental NGO’s: Sustainability Stewardship, Lap
Lambert Academic Publishing, India, ISBN-13: 978-6200442444.
231
2. Dodds, F. (2007). NGO diplomacy: The influence of nongovernmental organizations in
international environmental negotiations. Mit Press, Cambridge, ISBN-13: 978-0262524766.
3. Ghosh, S. (Ed.). (2019). Indian environmental law: Key concepts and principles. Orient
BlackSwan, India, ISBN-13: 978-9352875795.
4. Alan Fowler and Chiku Malunga (2010) NGO Management: The Earthscan Companion,
Routledge, ISBN-13 : 978-1849711197.
UNIT-II (9)
Regulatory Institutions – SEBI, TRAI, Competition Commission of India,
UNIT-III (9)
Lobbying Institutions: Chambers of Commerce and Industries, Trade Unions, Farmers
Associations, etc.
UNIT- IV (9)
Contemporary Political Economy of Development in India: Policy Debates over Models of
Development in India, Recent trends of Liberalisation of Indian Economy in different sectors,
E‐governance
UNIT-V (9)
Dynamics of Civil Society: New Social Movements, Role of NGO’s, Understanding the political
significance of Media and Popular Culture.
TOTAL 45 : PERIODS
REFERENCES:
1. Atul Kohli (ed.): The Success of India’s Democracy, Cambridge University Press, 2001.
2. Corbridge, Stuart and John Harris: Reinventing India: Liberalisation, Hindu Nationalism and
Popular Democracy, Oxford University Press, 2000.
3. J.Dreze and A.Sen, India: Economic Development and Social Opportunity, Clarendon, 1995.
4. Saima Saeed: Screening the Public Sphere: Media and Democracy in India,2013
5. Himat Singh: Green Revolution Reconsidered: The Rural World of Punjab, OUP, 2001.
6. Jagdish Bhagwati: India in Transition: Freeing The Economy, 1993.
7. Smitu Kothari: Social Movements and the Redefinition of Democracy, Boulder, Westview, 1993.
232
UNIT – I ENERGY SCENARIO 9
Indian energy scenario in various sectors – domestic, industrial, commercial, agriculture,
transportation and others – Present conventional energy status – Present renewable energy
status-Potential of various renewable energy sources-Global energy status-Per capita energy
consumption - Future energy plans
UNIT – IV BIO-ENERGY 9
Bio resources – Biomass direct combustion – thermochemical conversion - biochemical
conversion-mechanical conversion - Biomass gasifier - Types of biomass gasifiers - Cogeneration
–- Carbonisation – Pyrolysis - Biogas plants – Digesters –Biodiesel production – Ethanol
production - Applications.
REFERENCES
1. https://www.ideou.com/pages/design-thinking#process
2. https://blog.forgefor ward.in/valuation-risk-versus-validation-risk-in-product-innovations-
49f253ca86 24
3. https://blog.forgefor ward.in/product-innovation-rubric-adf5ebdfd356
4. https://blog.forgefor ward.in/evaluating-product-innovations-e8178e58b86e
5. https://blog.forgefor ward.in/user-guide-for-product-innovation-rubric-857181b253dd
6. https://blog.forgefor ward.in/star tup-failure-is-like-true-lie-7812cdfe9b85
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Robert W. Messler, Reverse Engineering: Mechanisms, Structures, Systems & Materials, 1st
Edition, McGraw-Hill Education, 2014
2. Wego Wang, Reverse Engineering Technology of Reinvention, CRC Press, 2011
REFERENCES:
1. Scott J. Lawrence , Principles of Reverse Engineering, Kindle Edition, 2022
2. Kevin Otto and Kristin Wood, Product Design: Techniques in Reverse Engineering and New
Product Development, Prentice Hall, 2001
3. Kathryn, A. Ingle, “Reverse Engineering”, McGraw-Hill, 1994.
4. Linda Wills, “Reverse Engineering”, Kluver Academic Publishers, 1996
5. Vinesh Raj and Kiran Fernandes, “Reverse Engineering: An Industrial Perspective”, Springer-
Verlag London Limited 2008.
236
OPR351 SUSTAINABLE MANUFACTURING L TP C
300 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
To be acquainted with sustainability in manufacturing and its evaluation.
To provide knowledge in environment and social sustainability.
To provide the student with the knowledge of strategy to achieve sustainability.
To familiarize with trends in sustainable operations.
To create awareness in current sustainable practices in manufacturing industry.
237
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Ibrahim Garbie, “Sustainability in Manufacturing Enterprises Concepts, Analyses and
Assessments for Industry 4.0”, Springer International Publishing., United States, 2016,
ISBN-13: 978-3319293042.
2. Davim J.P., “Sustainable Manufacturing”, John Wiley & Sons., United States, 2010,ISBN:
978-1-848-21212-1.
REFERENCES:
1. Jovane F, Ęmper, W.E. and Williams, D.J., “The ManuFuture Road: Towards
Competitive and Sustainable High-Adding-Value Manufacturing”, Springer,2009, United
States, ISBN 978-3-540-77011-4.
2. Kutz M., “Environmentally Conscious Mechanical Design”, John Wiley & Sons., United
States, 2007, ISBN: 978-0-471-72636-4.
3. Seliger G., “Sustainable Manufacturing: Shaping Global Value Creation”, Springer,
United States, 2012, ISBN 978-3-642-27289-9.
238
UNIT IV POWER CONVERTERS AND CONTROLLERS 9
Solid state Switching elements and characteristics – BJT, MOSFET, IGBT, SCR and TRIAC -
Power Converters – rectifiers, inverters and converters - Motor Drives - DC, AC motor, PMSM
motors, BLDC motors, Switched reluctance motors – four quadrant operations –operating modes
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Iqbal Husain, “ Electric and Hybrid Vehicles-Design Fundamentals”, CRC Press,2003
2. Mehrdad Ehsani, “ Modern Electric, Hybrid Electric and Fuel Cell Vehicles”, CRCPress,2005.
REFERENCES:
1. James Larminie and John Lowry, “Electric Vehicle Technology Explained “ John Wiley &
Sons,2003
2. Lino Guzzella, “ Vehicle Propulsion System” Springer Publications,2005
3. Ron HodKinson, “Light Weight Electric/ Hybrid Vehicle Design”, Butterworth Heinemann
Publication,2005.
PO PSO
CO
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 1 1 2 1 3 2 2 1 3
2 1 1 2 1 3 2 2 1 3
3 1 1 2 1 3 2 2 1 3
4 1 1 2 1 3 2 2 1 3
5 1 1 2 1 3 2 2 1 3
Avg. 1 1 2 1 3 2 2 1 3
239
UNIT II AERODYNAMICS 10
Aerodynamic forces – Lift generation Viscosity and its implications - Shear stress in a velocity
profile - Lagrangian and Eulerian flow field - Concept of a streamline – Aircraft terminology and
geometry - Aircraft types - Lift and drag coefficients using NACA data.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. John D. Anderson, Introduction to Flight, 8 th Ed., McGraw-Hill Education, New York,2015.
2. E Rathakrishnan, “Introduction to Aerospace Engineering: Basic Principles of Flight”, John
Wiley, NJ, 2021.
3. Stephen. A. Brandt, " Introduction to Aeronautics: A design perspective " American
Institute of Aeronautics & Astronautics,1997.
REFERENCE:
1. Kermode, A.C., “Mechanics of Flight”, Himalayan Book, 1997.
240
Directors - Committees - Chief Executive Line and Functional Managers,-Financial-Legal-Trade
Union
UNIT IV GROUPDYNAMICS 9
Group Behaviour - Groups - Contributing factors - Group Norms, Communication - Process -
Barriers to communication - Effective communication, leadership - formal and informal
characteristics – Managerial Grid - Leadership styles - Group Decision Making - Leadership Role
in Group Decision, Group Conflicts - Types -Causes - Conflict Resolution -Inter group relations
and conflict, Organization centralization and decentralization - Formal and informal -
Organizational Structures Organizational Change and Development -Change Process –
Resistance to Change - Culture and Ethics.
REFERENCES:
Maynard H.B, “Industrial Engineering Hand book”, McGraw-Hill, sixth 2008
CO’s PO’s PSO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 2 1 2 1
2 3 2 3 2
3 2 3 2 3 1 2 3
4 2 2 3 3 3 3
5 2 2 2
AVg. 2 2.2 2.3 3 1.8 2 2.6
241
OIE354 QUALITY ENGINEERING L T P C
3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES
Developing a clear knowledge in the basics of various quality concepts.
Facilitating the students in understanding the application of control charts and its
techniques.
Developing thespecialcontrolproceduresforserviceandprocessorientedindustries.
Analyzing and understanding the process capability study.
Developing the acceptance sampling procedures for incoming raw material.
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Quality Dimensions–Quality definitions–Inspection-Quality control–Quality Assurance–Quality
planning-Quality costs–Economics of quality– Quality loss function
UNIT II CONTROLCHARTS 9
Chance and assignable causes of process variation, statistical basis of the control chart, control
charts for variables- X , R and S charts, attribute control charts - p, np, c and u- Construction and
application.
UNIT IV STATISTICALPROCESSCONTROL 9
Process stability, process capability analysis using a Histogram or probability plots and control
chart.Gauge capability studies,setting specification limits.
UNITV ACCEPTANCESAMPLING 9
The acceptance sampling fundamental, OC curve, sampling plans for attributes, simple, double,
multiple and sequential, sampling plans for variables,MIL-STD-105DandMIL-STD-414E&IS2500
standards.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Students will be able to:
CO1: Control the quality of processes using control charts for variables in manufacturing industries.
CO2: Control the occurrence of defective product and the defects in manufacturing companies.
CO3: Control the occurrence of defects in services.
CO4: Analyzing and understanding the process capability study.
CO5: Developing the acceptance sampling procedures for incoming raw material.
PO’s PSO’s
CO’s 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 2 3 3 3 1 2 2 1
2 3 3 3 3 3 3 2
3 3 3 3 3 3 3 1
4 3 2 3 1 1
5 2 3 3 3 1
AVg. 2.6 2.7 2.7 3 3 1 2.7 1 2.7 1 2 1
242
OSF351 FIRE SAFETY ENGINEERING L T P C
3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES
1:To enable the students to acquire knowledge of Fire and Safety Studies
2:To learn about the effect of fire on materials used for construction, the method of test for non-
combustibility & fire resistance
3:To learn about fire area, fire stopped areas and different types of fire-resistant doors
4:To learn about the method of fire protection of structural members and their repair due to fire
damage.
5:To develop safety professionals for both technical and management through systematic and
quality-based study programmes
244
UNIT III EDDY CURRENT TESTING & THERMOGRAPHY 9
Eddy Current Testing: Generation of eddy currents– properties– eddy current sensing elements,
probes, Instrumentation, Types of arrangement, applications, advantages, limitations – Factors
affecting sensing elements and coil impedance, calibration, Interpretation/Evaluation.
Thermography- Principle, Contact & Non-Contact inspection methods, Active & Passive methods,
Liquid Crystal – Concept, example, advantages & limitations. Electromagnetic spectrum, infrared
thermography- approaches, IR detectors, Instrumentation and methods, applications.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Baldev Raj, T. Jayakumar and M. Thavasimuthu, Practical Non Destructive Testing, Alpha
Science International Limited, 3rd edition, 2002.
2. J. Prasad and C. G. K. Nair, Non-Destructive Test and Evaluation of Materials, Tata
McGraw-Hill Education, 2nd edition, 2011.
3. Ravi Prakash, “Non-Destructive Testing Techniques”, 1st revised edition, New Age
International Publishers, 2010.
REFERENCES:
1. ASM Metals Handbook, V-17, "Nondestructive Evaluation and Quality Control", American
Society of Metals, USA, 2001.
2. Barry Hull and Vernon John,"Nondestructive Testing", Macmillan, 1989.
3. Chuck Hellier, “Handbook of Nondestructive Evaluation”, Mc Graw Hill, 2012.
4. Louis Cartz, "Nondestructive Testing", ASM International, USA, 1995.
245
PSO PSO PSO
PO1 PO2 PO3 PO4 PO5 PO6 PO7 PO8 PO9 PO10 PO11 PO12
1 2 3
C01 2 2 2 3 2 2 2 1 2
C02 3 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1
C03 3 2 1 2 2 2 2 2 2
CO4 3 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
CO5 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1
Avg 2.8 1.6 1.8 2.2 2 2 2 1.8 2 1.3
OMR351 MECHATRONICS L T P C
3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
The main learning objective of this course is to prepare the students for:
1. Selecting sensors to develop mechatronics systems.
2. Explaining the architecture and timing diagram of microprocessor, and also
interpret and develop programs.
3. Designing appropriate interfacing circuits to connect I/O devices with
microprocessor.
4. Applying PLC as a controller in mechatronics system.
5. Designing and develop the apt mechatronics system for an application.
TEXT BOOKS
1. Bolton W., “Mechatronics”, Pearson Education, 6th Edition, 2015.
2. Ramesh S Gaonkar, “Microprocessor Architecture, Programming, and
Applications with the 8085”, Penram International Publishing Private Limited, 6th
Edition, 2013.
REFERENCES
1. Bradley D.A., Dawson D., Buru N.C. and Loader A.J., “Mechatronics”, Chapman
and Hall, 1993.
2. Davis G. Alciatore and Michael B. Histand, “Introduction to Mechatronics and
Measurement systems”, McGraw Hill Education, 2011.
3. Devadas Shetty and Richard A. Kolk, “Mechatronics Systems Design”, Cengage
Learning, 2010.
4. Nitaigour Premchand Mahalik, “Mechatronics Principles, Concepts and
Applications”, McGraw Hill Education, 2015.
5. Smaili. A and Mrad. F, “Mechatronics Integrated Technologies for Intelligent
Machines”, Oxford University Press, 2007.
247
UNIT – I FUNDAMENTALS OF ROBOT 9
Robot – Definition – Robot Anatomy – Co-ordinate systems, Work Envelope, types and
classification – specifications – Pitch, yaw, Roll, Joint Notations, Speed of Motion, Pay Load –
Robot Parts and their functions – Need for Robots – Different Applications.
REFERENCES:
1. Fu K.S. Gonalz R.C. and ice C.S.G.”Robotics Control, Sensing, Vision and Intelligence”,
McGraw Hill book co. 2007.
2. YoramKoren, “Robotics for Engineers”, McGraw Hill Book, Co., 2002.
3. Janakiraman P.A., “Robotics and Image Processing”, Tata McGraw Hill 2005.
4. John. J.Craig, “Introduction to Robotics: Mechanics and Control” 2nd Edition, 2002.
5. Jazar, “Theory of Applied Robotics: Kinematics, Dynamics and Control”, Springer India
reprint, 2010.
249
ge and constructions.
TEXT BOOKS
1. Anderson, J.D., Introduction to Flight, McGraw-Hill; 8th edition , 2015
2. . E Rathakrishnan, “Introduction to Aerospace Engineering: Basic Principles of Flight”, John
Wiley, NJ, 2021
3. Stephen.A. Brandt, Introduction to aeronautics: A design perspective, 2nd edition, AIAA
Education Series, 2004.
REFERENCE
1. SADHU SINGH, “INTERNAL COMBUSTION ENGINES AND GAS TURBINE”-, SS
Kataraia & sons, 2015
2. KERMODE , “FLIGHT WITHOUT FORMULAE”, -, Pitman; 4th Revised edition 1989
250
UNIT V DATA PRODUCTS AND INTERPRETATION 9
Photographic and digital products – Types, levels and open source satellite data products –-
selection and procurement of data– Visual interpretation: basic elements and interpretation keys -
Digital interpretation – Concepts of Image rectification, Image enhancement and Image
classification
TOTAL:45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
On completion of the course, the student is expected to
CO 1 Understand the concepts and laws related to remote sensing
CO 2 Understand the interaction of electromagnetic radiation with atmosphere and earth material
CO 3 Acquire knowledge about satellite orbits and different types of satellites
CO 4 Understand the different types of remote sensors
CO 5 Gain knowledge about the concepts of interpretation of satellite imagery
TEXTBOOKS:
1. Thomas M.Lillesand, Ralph W. Kiefer and Jonathan W. Chipman, Remote Sensing and
Image interpretation, John Wiley and Sons, Inc, New York,2015.
2. George Joseph and C Jeganathan, Fundamentals of Remote Sensing,Third Edition
Universities Press (India) Private limited, Hyderabad, 2018
REFERENCES:
1. Janza, F.Z., Blue H.M. and Johnson,J.E. Manual of Remote Sensing. Vol.1, American
Society of Photogrametry, Virginia, USA, 2002.
2. Verbyla, David, Satellite Remote Sensing of Natural Resources. CRC Press, 1995
3. Paul Curran P.J. Principles of Remote Sensing. Longman, RLBS, 1988.
4. Introduction to Physics and Techniques of Remote Sensing , Charles Elachi and Jacob Van
Zyl, 2006 Edition II, Wiley Publication.
5. Basudeb Bhatta, Remote Sensing and GIS, Oxford University Press, 2011
CO-PO MAPPING
Course Outcome
PO Graduate Attribute CO1 CO2 CO3 CO4 CO5 Average
PO1 Engineering Knowledge 3 3 3 3 3 3
PO2 Problem Analysis 3 3 3
PO3 Design/Development of Solutions 3 3 3
PO4 Conduct Investigations of Complex 3
3 3
Problems
PO5 Modern Tool Usage 3 3 3
PO6 The Engineer and Society
PO 7 Environment and Sustainability
PO 8 Ethics
PO 9 Individual and Team Work
PO 10 Communication
PO 11 Project Management and Finance
PO 12 Life-long Learning 3 3 3 3 3
PSO 1 Knowledge of Geoinformatics discipline 3 3 3 3 3 3
PSO 2 Critical analysis of Geoinformatics 3
3 3 3 3 3
Engineering problems and innovations
PSO 3 Conceptualization and evaluation of 3
3 3 3 3 3
Design solutions
251
OAI351 URBAN AGRICULTURE LTPC
3 003
OBJECTIVES:
To introduce the students the principles of agricultural crop production and the production
practices of crops in modern ways.
To delineate the role of agricultural engineers in relation to various crop production practices.
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Benefits of urban agriculture- economic benefits, environmental benefits, social and cultural
benefits, educational, skill-building and job training benefits, health, nutrition and food accessibility
benefits.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Martellozzo F and J S Landry. 2020. Urban Agriculture. Scitus Academics Llc.
2. Rob Roggema. 2016. Sustainable Urban Agriculture and Food Planning. Routledge Taylor and
Francis Group.
3. Akrong M O. 2012. Urban Agriculture. LAP Lambert Academic Publishing.
REFERENCES:
1. Agha Rokh A. 2008. Evaluation of ornamental flowers and fishes breeding in Bushehr urban
wastewater using a pilot-scale aquaponic system. Water and Wastewater, 19 (65): 47–53.
2. Agrawal M, Singh B, Rajput M, Marshall F and Bell J. N. B. 2003. Effect of air pollution on peri-
urban agriculture: A case study. Environmental Pollution, 126 (3): 323–329.
https://www.sciencedirect.com/science/article/pii/S0269749103002458#aep-section-id24.
252
3. Jac Smit and Joe Nasr. 1992. Urban agriculture for sustainable cities: using wastes and idle
land and water bodies as resources. Environment and Urbanization, 4 (2):141-152.
CO-PO MAPPING
PO/PSO CO1 CO2 CO3 CO4 CO5 Overall
correlation of
COs with POs
PO1 Engineering Knowledge 1 2 1 1 2 1
PO2 Problem Analysis 1 1 1 1 1 2
PO3 Design/ Development of Solutions 1 2 1 1 3 2
PO4 Conduct Investigations of
1 1 2 2 1 1
Complex Problems
PO5 Modern Tool Usage 1 2 1 1 1 2
PO6 The Engineer and Society 1 2 1 2 1 1
PO7 Environment and sustainability 1 2 1 1 2 1
PO8 Ethics 2 1 1 1 2 1
PO9 Individual and team work: 1 1 2 1 1 1
PO10 Communication 1 2 1 1 2 1
PO11 Project management and finance 1 1 1 1 1 2
PO12 Life-long learning: 1 2 1 1 3 2
PSO1 To make expertise in design and
engineering problem solving
1 2 1 1 2 1
approach in agriculture with
proper knowledge and skill
PSO2 To enhance students ability to
formulate solutions to real-world
problems pertaining to 2 1 2 1 1 1
sustained agricultural productivity
using modern technologies.
PSO3 To inculcate entrepreneurial skills
through strong Industry-Institution 1 2 1 2 1 2
linkage.
253
UNIT III WATER TREATMENT 9
Objectives – Unit operations and processes – Principles, functions, and design of water treatment
plant units, aerators of flash mixers, Coagulation and flocculation –- sand filters - Disinfection -–
Construction, Operation and Maintenance aspects.
TEXTBOOKS :
1. Garg. S.K., "Water Supply Engineering", Khanna Publishers, Delhi, September 2008.
2. Punmia B.C, Arun K.Jain, Ashok K.Jain, “ Water supply Engineering” Lakshmi publication
private limited, New Delhi, 2016.
3. Rangwala "Water Supply and Sanitary Engineering", February 2022
4. Birdie.G.S., "Water Supply and Sanitary Engineering", Dhanpat Rai and sons, 2018.
REFERENCES :
1. Fair. G.M., Geyer.J.C., "Water Supply and Wastewater Disposal", John Wiley and Sons,
1954.
2. Babbit.H.E, and Donald.J.J, "Water Supply Engineering" , McGraw Hill book Co, 1984.
3. Steel. E.W.et al., "Water Supply Engineering" , Mc Graw Hill International book Co, 1984.
4. Duggal. K.N., “Elememts of public Health Engineering”, S.Chand and Company Ltd,
New Delhi, 1998.
PO’s PSO’s
CO’s 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 3 3 3 3
2 3 2 2 3 3
3 2 2 3 3
4 3 2 3 2 3 3
5 3 2 1 2 3 1
Avg. 3 3 2 2 1 3 2 3 1 3
254
OEE352 ELECTRIC VEHICLE TECHNOLOGY LTPC
300 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES
To provide knowledge about electric machines and special machine
To understand the basics of power converters
To know the concepts of controlling DC and AC drive systems
To understand the architecture and power train components.
To impart knowledge on vehicle control for standard drive cycles of hybrid electrical
vehicles (HEVs)
255
P P P P P PS PS PS
PO P P P P P P
O O O O O O1 O2 O3
1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 O7
8 9 10 11 12
CO1 3 2 3 3 3 3
CO2 3 2 2 3 3 3 3 3
CO3 3 3 2 2 3 3 3
CO4 3 2 2 3 3 3 3
CO5 3 2 2 3 3 3
Avg 3 2 2 3 3 1 2 3 2 3 3 3
REFERENCES:
1 Stephen D. Umans, “Fitzgerald & Kingsley’s Electric Machinery”, Tata McGraw Hill, 7 th Edition,
2020.
2 Bogdan M. Wilamowski, J. David Irwin, The Industrial Electronics Handbook, Second Edition,
Power Electronics and Motor Drives, CRC Press, 2011
3 Paul C. Krause, Oleg Wasynczuk, Scott D. Sudhoff, Steven D. Pekarek “Analysis of Electric
Machinery and Drive Systems”, 3rd Edition, Wiley-IEEE Press, 2013.
4 Rashid M.H., “Power Electronics Circuits, Devices and Applications ", Pearson, fourth Edition,
10th Impression 2021.
5 Iqbal Husain, ‘Electric and Hybrid Electric Vehicles’, CRC Press, 2021.
6 Wei Liu, ‘Hybrid Electric Vehicle System Modeling and Control’, Second Edition, WILEY, 2017
7 James Larminie and John Lowry, ‘Electric Vehicle Technology Explained’, Second Edition,
Wiley, 2012
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1 Know the basic requirement of a PLC input/output devices and architecture. (L1)
CO2 Ability to apply Basics Instruction Sets used for ladder Logic and Function Block
Programming.(L2)
CO3 Ability to design PLC Programmes by Applying Timer/Counter and Arithmetic and Logic
Instructions Studied for Ladder Logic and Function BIock.(L3)
CO4 Able to develop a PLC logic for a specific application on real world problem. (L5)
CO5 Ability to Understand the Concepts of Communication used for PLC/SCADA.(L1)
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Frank Petruzzula, Programmable Logic Controllers, Tata Mc-Graw Hill Edition
2. John W. Webb, Ronald A. Reis, Programmable Logic Controllers Principles and
Applications, PHI publication
REFERENCES:
1. MadhuchanndMitra and SamerjitSengupta, Programmable Logic Controllers Industrial
Automation an Introduction, Penram International Publishing Pvt. Ltd.
2. J. R. Hackworth and F. D. Hackworth, Programmable Logic Controllers Principles
andApplications, Pearson publication
257
CO5 3 3 3 2 1 1 1 3 3 3
Avg 3 2.9 2.25 2.6 1.6 1 1 3 3 2.9
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Sen, Colleen Taylor “Food Culture in India” Greenwood Press, 2005.
2. Davidar, Ruth N. “Indian Food Science: A Health and Nutrition Guide to Traditional Recipes:
East West Books, 2001.
258
OFD353 INTRODUCTION TO FOOD PROCESSING LTPC
3003
OBJECTIVE:
The course aims to introduce the students to the area of Food Processing. This is necessary for
effective understanding of a detailed study of food processing and technology subjects. This
course will enable students to appreciate the importance of food processing with respect to the
producer, manufacturer and consumer.
TEXT BOOKS/REFERENCES:
1. Karnal, Marcus and D.B. Lund “Physical Principles of Food Preservation”. Rutledge, 2003.
2. VanGarde, S.J. and Woodburn. M “Food Preservation and Safety Principles and
Practice”.Surbhi Publications, 2001.
3. Sivasankar, B. “Food Processing & Preservation”, Prentice Hall of India, 2002.
4. Khetarpaul, Neelam, “Food Processing and Preservation”, Daya Publications, 2005.
259
OPY352 IPR FOR PHARMA INDUSTRY LTPC
3003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
To provide the basic fundamental knowledge of different forms of Intellectual
Property Rights in national and international level.
To provide the significance of the Intellectual Property Rights about the patents,
copyrights, industrial design, plant and geographical indications.
This paper is to study significance of the amended patent act on pharma industry.
UNIT II PATENTS 9
Patents-Objective, Introduction, Requirement for patenting- Novelty, Inventive step (Non-
obviousness) and industrial application (utility), Non-patentable inventions, rights of patent owner,
assignment of patent rights, patent specification (provisional and complete), parts of complete
specification, claims, procedure for obtaining patents, compulsory license.
REFERENCES:
1. Patents for Chemicals, Pharmaceuticals, & Biotechnology-Fundamentals of Global Law,
Practice and Strategy. Philip W. Grubb, Oxford University Press, 2004.
2. Basic Principles of patent law – Basics principles and acquisition of IPR. Ramakrishna T.
CIPRA, NLSIU, Bangalore, 2005
3. S. Lakshmana Prabu, TNK. Suriyaprakash, “Intellectual Property Rights”, 1st ed., In Tech open
access, Croatia, 2017.
260
Course Outcome
The student will be able to
C1 Understand and differentiate the categories of intellectual property rights.
C2 Describe about patents and procedure for obtaining patents.
C3 Distinguish plant variety, traditional knowledge and geographical indications under IPR.
C4 Provide the information about the different enforcements and practical aspects involved in
protection of IPR.
C5 Provide different organizations role and responsibilities in the protection of IPR in the
international level.
C6 Understand the interrelationships between different Intellectual Property Rights on
International Society
CO – PO MAPPING
IPR FOR PHARMA INDUSTRY
PO1 PO2 PO PO4 PO5 PO6 PO7 PO8 PO9 PO1 PO11 PO
3 0 12
C1 3 3 2 2 2
C2 3 3 2 2
C3 3 3 2 2 1
C4 2 3 3 2 2
C5 3 3 2 1
C6 3 2 2 2 2
261
clusters of metals, semiconductors and nanocomposites. Spectroscopic techniques, Diffraction
methods, thermal analysis method, BET analysis method.
TEXT BOOKS
1. Mick Wilson, Kamali Kannangara,Geoff Smith, Michelle Simmom, Burkhard Raguse, “ Nano
Technology: Basic Science & Engineering Technology”, 2005, Overseas Press
2. G. Cao, “Nanostructures & Nanomaterials: Synthesis, Properties &Applications” Imperial
College Press, 2004
3.William A Goddard “Handbook of Nanoscience, Engineering and Technology”, 3rd Edition, CRC
Taylor and Francis group 2012.
REFERENCES
1. R.H.J.Hannink & A.J.Hill, Nanostructure Control, Wood Head Publishing Ltd.,Cambridge,
2006.
2. C.N.R.Rao, A.Muller, A.K.Cheetham, The Chemistry of Nanomaterials: Synthesis,
Properties and Applications Vol. I & II, 2nd edition, 2005, Wiley VCH Verlag Gibtl & Co
3. Ivor Brodie and Julius J.Muray,’The physics of Micro/Nano – Fabrication’,Springer
International Edition,2010
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Historical Perspectives, Lessons from the Nature, Engineering the Functions, Tuning the functions,
Multiscale Modeling and Computation, Classification of Functional Materials, Functional Diversity
of Materials, Hybrid Materials, Technological Relevance, Societal Impact.
263
OUTCOME:
Students will be able to differentiate among various functional properties and select
appropriate material for certain functional applications, analyze the nature and potential of
functional material.
TEXT BOOK:
1. Vijayamohanan K. Pillai and MeeraParthasarathy, “Functional Materials: A
chemist’s perpective”, Universities Press Hyderabad (2012).
REFERENCE:
1. Stephen Manne “Biomimetic Materials Chemistry” Wiley-VCH Newyork, 1966.
UNIT II CRACKING 9
Cracking, Thermal Cracking, Vis-breaking, Catalytic Cracking (FCC), Hydro Cracking, Coking and
Air Blowing of Bitumen
264
.
OUTCOMES:
On the completion of the course students are expected to
CO1: Understand the classification, composition and testing methods of crude petroleum
and its products. Learn the mechanism of refining process.
CO2: Understand the insights of primary treatment processes to produce the precursors.
CO3: Study the secondary treatment processes cracking, vis-breaking and coking to
produce more petroleum products.
CO4: Appreciate the need of treatment techniques for the removal of sulphur and other
impurities from petroleum products.
CO5: Understand the societal impact of petrochemicals and learn their manufacturing
processes.
CO6: Learn the importance of optimization of process parameters for the high yield of
petroleum products.
TEXT BOOKS
1. Nelson, W. L., “Petroleum Refinery Engineering”, 4th Edition., McGraw Hill, New
York,1985.
2. Wiseman. P., "Petrochemicals", UMIST Series in Science and Technology, John Wiley &
Sons,1986.
REFERENCES
1. Bhaskara Rao, B. K., “Modern Petroleum Refining Processes”, 2nd Edition, Oxford and
IBH Publishing Company, New Delhi, 1990.
2. Bhaskara Rao, B. K. “A Text on Petrochemicals”, 1st Edition, Khanna Publishers
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Energy - Power – Past & Present scenario of World; National Energy consumption Data –
Environmental aspects associated with energy utilization – Energy Auditing: Need, Types,
Methodology and Barriers. Role of Energy Managers. Instruments for energy auditing.
UNIT V ECONOMICS 9
Energy Economics – Discount Rate, Payback Period, Internal Rate of Return, Net Present
Value, Life Cycle Costing –ESCO concept
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of this course, the students can able to analyze the energy data of
industries.
CO1: Remember the knowledge for Basic combustion and furnace design and
selection of thermal and mechanical energy equipment.
CO2: Study the Importance of Stoichiometry relations, Theoretical air required for
complete combustion.
CO3: Skills on combustion thermodynamics and kinetics.
CO4: Apply calculation and design tube still heaters.
CO5: Studied different heat treatment furnace.
CO6: Practical and theoretical knowledge burner design.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Energy Manager Training Manual (4 Volumes) available at
www.energymanagertraining.com. a website administered by Bureau of Energy
Efficiency (BEE), a statutory body under Ministry of Power, Government of India,
2004.
REFERENCES:
1. Witte. L.C., P.S. Schmidt, D.R. Brown, “Industrial Energy Management and
Utilisation” Hemisphere Publ, Washington, 1988.
2. Callaghn, P.W. “Design and Management for Energy Conservation”, Pergamon
Press, Oxford, 1981.
3. Dryden. I.G.C., “The Efficient Use of Energy” Butterworths, London, 1982
4. Turner. W.C., “Energy Management Hand book”, Wiley, New York, 1982.
5. Murphy. W.R. and G. Mc KAY, “Energy Management”, Butterworths, London 1987
266
UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO PLASTICS PROCESSING 9
Introduction to plastic processing – Principles of plastic processing: processing of plastics vs.
metals and ceramics. Factors influencing the efficiency of plastics processing: molecular
weight, viscosity and rheology. Difference in approach for thermoplastic and thermoset
processing. Additives for plastics compounding and processing: antioxidants, light
stabilizers, UV stabilizers, lubricants, impact modifiers, flame retardants, antistatic agents,
stabilizers and plasticizers. Compounding: plastic compounding techniques, plasticization,
pelletization.
UNIT II EXTRUSION 9
Extrusion – Principles of extrusion. Features of extruder: barrel, screw, types of screws,
drive mechanism, specifications, heating & cooling systems, types of extruders. Flow
mechanism: process variables, die entry effects and exit instabilities. Die swell, Defects: melt
fracture, shark skin, bambooing. Factors determining efficiency of an extruder. Extrusion of
films: blown and cast films. Tube/pipe extrusion. Extrusion coating: wire & cable. Twin screw
extruder and its applications. Applications of extrusion and new developments.
REFERENCES
1. S. S. Schwart, S. H. Goodman, Plastics Materials and Processes, Van Nostrad
Reinhold Company Inc. (1982).
2. F. Hensen (Ed.), Plastic Extrusion Technology, Hanser Gardner (1997).
3. W. S. Allen and P. N. Baker, Hand Book of Plastic Technology, Volume-1, Plastic
Processing Operations [Injection, Compression, Transfer, Blow Molding], CBS
Publishers and Distributors (2004).
4. M. Chanda, S. K. Roy, Plastic Technology handbook, 4th Edn., CRC Press (2007).
5. I. I. Rubin, Injection Molding Theory & Practice, Society of Plastic Engineers, Wiley
(1973).
6. D.V. Rosato, M. G. Rosato, Injection Molding Hand Book, Springer (2012).
7. M. L. Berins (Ed.), SPI Plastic Engineering Hand Book of Society of Plastic Industry
Inc., Springer (2012).
8. B. Strong, Plastics: Material & Processing, A, Pearson Prentice hall (2005).
9. D.V Rosato, Blow Molding Hand Book, Carl HanserVerlag GmbH & Co (2003).
268
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of the course, the student will be able to:
CO1:determine if a given system is linear/causal/stable
CO2: determine the frequency components present in a deterministic signal
CO3:characterize continuous LTI systems in the time domain and frequency domain
CO4:characterize discrete LTI systems in the time domain and frequency domain
CO5:compute the output of an LTI system in the time and frequency domains
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Oppenheim, Willsky and Hamid, “Signals and Systems”, 2nd Edition, Pearson
Education, New Delhi, 2015.(Units I - V)
2. Simon Haykin, Barry Van Veen, “Signals and Systems”, 2nd Edition, Wiley, 2002
REFERENCES :
1. B. P. Lathi, “Principles of Linear Systems and Signals”, 2nd Edition, Oxford, 2009.
2. M. J. Roberts, “Signals and Systems Analysis using Transform methods and
MATLAB”, McGraw- Hill Education, 2018.
3. John Alan Stuller, “An Introduction to Signals and Systems”, Thomson, 2007.
C PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PS
O 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 O1 O2 O3
1 3 - 3 - 3 2 - - - - 3 - - 1
2 3 - 3 - - 2 - - - - 3 - 3 -
3 3 3 - - 3 2 - - - - 3 2 - -
4 3 3 - - 3 2 - - - - 3 - 3 1
5 3 3 - 3 3 2 - - - - 3 - 3 1
C 3 3 3 3 3 2 - - - - - 3 2 3 1
O
269
UNIT II AMPLIFIERS 9
Load line, operating point, biasing methods for BJT and MOSFET, BJT small signal model –
Analysis of CE, CB, CC amplifiers- Gain and frequency response –Analysis of CS and Source
follower – Gain and frequency response- High frequency analysis.
TEXT BOOKS :
1. David A. Bell, "Electronic Devices and Circuits", Oxford Higher Education press, 5 th
Edition, 2010.
2. Robert L. Boylestad and Louis Nasheresky, “Electronic Devices and Circuit Theory”,
10th Edition, Pearson Education / PHI, 2008.
3. Adel .S. Sedra, Kenneth C. Smith, "Micro Electronic Circuits", Oxford University
Press, 7 th Edition, 2014.
REFERENCES :
1. Donald.A. Neamen, "Electronic Circuit Analysis and Design", Tata McGraw Hill, 3
rd Edition, 2010.
2. D.Schilling and C.Belove, "Electronic Circuits", McGraw Hill, 3 rd Edition, 1989
3. Muhammad H.Rashid, "Power Electronics", Pearson Education / PHI , 2004.
PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PS
CO
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 O1 O2 O3
1 3 3 3 3 2 1 - - - - - 1 2 1 1
2 3 2 2 3 2 2 - - - - - 1 2 1 1
3 3 3 3 2 1 2 - - - - - 1 2 1 1
4 3 3 2 3 2 2 - - - - - 1 2 1 1
5 3 2 3 2 2 1 - - - - - 1 2 1 1
CO 3 3 3 3 2 2 - - - - - 1 2 1 1
270
CBM348 FOUNDATION SKILLS IN INTEGRATED PRODUCT DEVELOPMENT LTPC
3 003
OBJECTIVES:
• To understand the global trends and development methodologies of various types of
products and services
• To conceptualize, prototype and develop product management plan for a new product
based on the type of the new product and development methodology integrating the
hardware, software, controls, electronics and mechanical systems
• To understand requirement engineering and know how to collect, analyze and arrive at
requirements for new product development and convert them in to design specification
• To understand system modeling for system, sub-system and their interfaces and arrive
at the optimum system specification and characteristics
• To develop documentation, test specifications and coordinate with various teams to
validate and sustain up to the EoL (End of Life) support activities for engineering
customer
271
Define, formulate, and analyze a problem
Solve specific problems independently or as part of a team
Gain knowledge of the Innovation & Product Development process in the Business
Context
Work independently as well as in teams
Manage a project from start to finish
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Book specially prepared by NASSCOM as per the MoU.
2. Karl T Ulrich and Stephen D Eppinger, "Product Design and Development", Tata
McGraw Hill, Fifth Edition, 2011.
3. John W Newstorm and Keith Davis, "Organizational Behavior", Tata McGraw Hill,
Eleventh Edition, 2005.
REFERENCES:
1. Hiriyappa B, “Corporate Strategy – Managing the Business”, Author House, 2013.
2. Peter F Drucker, “People and Performance”, Butterworth – Heinemann [Elsevier],
Oxford, 2004.
3. Vinod Kumar Garg and Venkita Krishnan N K, “Enterprise Resource Planning –
Concepts”, Second Edition, Prentice Hall, 2003.
4. Mark S Sanders and Ernest J McCormick, "Human Factors in Engineering and
Design", McGraw Hill Education, Seventh Edition, 2013
272
UNIT II HEMODIALYSERS 9
Physiology of kidney, Artificial kidney, Dialysis action, hemodialyser unit, membrane dialysis,
portable dialyser monitoring and functional parameters.
TEXT BOOKS
1. Joseph D. Bronzino, The Biomedical Engineering Handbook, Third Edition: Three
Volume Set, CRC Press,2006
2. Marion. A. Hersh, Michael A. Johnson,Assistive Technology for visually impaired
and blind,Springer Science & Business Media, 1st edition, 12-May-2010
3. Yadin David, Wolf W. von Maltzahn, Michael R. Neuman, Joseph.D, Bronzino,
Clinical Engineering, CRC Press, 1st edition,2010.
REFERENCES
1. Kenneth J. Turner Advances in Home Care Technologies: Results of the match
Project, Springer, 1stedition, 2011.
2. Gerr M. Craddock Assistive Technology-Shaping the future, IOS Press, 1st edition,
2003.
3. 3D Printing in Orthopaedic Surgery, Matthew Dipaola , Elsevier 2019 ISBN 978 -0-
323-662116
4. Cardiac Assist Devices, Daniel Goldstein (Editor), Mehmet Oz (Editor), Wiley-
Blackwell April 2000 ISBN: 978-0-879-93449-1
273
OMA352 OPERATIONS RESEARCH L T P C
3 0 0 3
OBJECTIVES:
This course will help the students to
determine the optimum solution for Linear programming problems.
study the Transportation and assignment models and various techniques
to solve them.
acquire the knowledge of optimality, formulation and computation of integer
programming problems.
acquire the knowledge of optimality, formulation and computation of dynamic
programming problems.
determine the optimum solution for non-linear programming problems.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Kanti Swarup, P.K.Gupta and Man Mohan, " Operations Research " , Sultan
Chand & Sons, New Delhi, Fifth Edition , 1990.
274
2. Taha. H.A, " Operations Research – An Introduction , Pearson Education,
Ninth Edition , New Delhi, 2012.
REFERENCES :
1. J.K.Sharma , " Operations Research - Theory and Applications " Mac Millan
India Ltd , Second Edition , New Delhi , 2003.
2. Richard Bronson & Govindasami Naadimuthu , " Operations Research " (
Schaum’s Outlines – TMH Edition) Tata McGraw Hill, Second Edition, New Delhi,
2004.
3. Pradeep Prabhakar Pai , " Operations Research and Practice", Oxford
University Press, New Delhi , 2012.
4. J.P.Singh and N.P.Singh , " Operations Research , Ane Books Pvt.L.td, New
Delhi , 2014.
5. F.S.Hillier and G.J. Lieberman, " Introduction to Operations Research " , Tata
McGraw Hill, Eighth Edition , New Delhi, 2005.
PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PS
01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 O1 O2 O3
CO1 3 3 0 0 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2 - - -
CO2 3 3 3 2 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2 - - -
CO3 3 3 0 0 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2 - - -
CO4 3 3 0 0 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2 - - -
CO5 3 3 2 2 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2 - - -
Avg 3 3 1 0.8 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2 - - -
TEXT BOOKS :
1. Grimaldi, R.P and Ramana, B.V., "Discrete and Combinatorial Mathematics", Pearson
Education, 5th Edition, New Delhi, 2007.
2. Thomas Koshy, “Elementary Number Theory with Applications”, Elsevier
Publications , New Delhi , 2002.
REFERENCES:
1. San Ling and Chaoping Xing, “Coding Theory – A first Course”, Cambridge
Publications, Cambridge, 2004.
2. Niven.I, Zuckerman.H.S., and Montgomery, H.L., “An Introduction to Theory of
Numbers” , John Wiley and Sons , Singapore, 2004.
3. Lidl.R., and Pitz. G, "Applied Abstract Algebra", Springer Verlag, New Delhi, 2 nd
Edition , 2006.
PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PS
01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 O1 O2 O3
CO1 3 1 2 - - - 2 1 - 1 2 2 - - -
CO2 3 3 1 1 3 1 2 1 1 1 2 2 - - -
CO3 3 3 2 1 3 1 3 1 1 1 2 3 - - -
CO4 3 3 2 2 3 2 2 1 1 1 2 3 - - -
CO5 2 2 1 - 3 1 2 1 1 1 3 3 - - -
Avg 2.8 2.4 1.6 0.8 2.4 1 2.2 1 0.8 1 2.2 2.6 - - -
276
UNIT I MATRICES AND SYSTEM OF LINEAR EQUATIONS 9
Matrices - Row echelon form - Rank - System of linear equations - Consistency - Gauss
elimination method - Gauss Jordan method.
TEXT BOOKS
1. Faires J.D. and Burden R., Numerical Methods, Brooks/Cole (Thomson Publications), New
Delhi, 2002.
2. Friedberg A.H, Insel A.J. and Spence L, Linear Algebra, Pearson Education, 5th Edition,2019.
REFERENCES
1. Bernard Kolman, David R. Hill, Introductory Linear Algebra, Pearson Educations, New Delhi,
8th Edition, 2009.
2. Gerald C.F. and Wheatley P.O, Applied Numerical Analysis, Pearson Educations, New Delhi,
7th Edition, 2007.
3. Kumaresan S, Linear Algebra - A geometric approach, Prentice Hall of India, New Delhi,
Reprint, 2010.
4. Richard Branson, Matrix Operations, Schaum's outline series, 1989.
5. Strang G, Linear Algebra and its applications, Thomson (Brooks / Cole) New Delhi,
4th Edition, 2005.
6. Sundarapandian V, Numerical Linear Algebra, Prentice Hall of India, New Delhi, 2014.
PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PS
01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 O1 O2 O3
CO1 3 3 3 3 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 3 - - -
CO2 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 1 1 1 3 - - -
CO3 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 1 1 1 3 - - -
CO4 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 1 1 1 3 - - -
277
CO5 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 1 1 1 3 - - -
Avg 3 3 3 3 2.8 2 2 1 1 1 1 3 - - -
OBT352 BASICS OF MICROBIAL TECHNOLOGY LTPC
3003
COURSE OBJECTIVE:
Enable the Non-biological student’s to understand about the basics of life science
and their pro and cons for living organisms.
278
OBT353 BASICS OF BIOMOLECULES LTPC
3 003
OBJECTIVES:
The objective is to offer basic concepts of biochemistry to students with diverse
background in life sciences including but not limited to the structure and function of
various biomolecules and their metabolism.
UNIT I CARBOHYDRATES 9
Introduction to carbohydrate, classification, properties of monosaccharide, structural aspects of
monosaccharides. Introduction to disaccharide (lactose, maltose, sucrose) and polysaccharide
(Heparin, starch, and glycogen) biological function of carbohydrate.
OUTCOMES:
REFERENCES
1. Berg, Jeremy M. et al. “Biochemsitry”, 6th Edition, W.H. Freeman & Co., 2006.
2. Murray, R.K., etal “Harper’s Illustrated Biochemistry”, 31st Edition, McGraw-Hill, 2018.
3. Voet, D. and Voet, J.G., “Biochemistry”, 4th Edition, John Wiley & Sons Inc., 2010.
279
OBT354 FUNDAMENTALS OF CELL AND MOLECULAR BIOLOGY LTPC
3 003
OBJECTIVES:
To provide knowledge on the fundamentals of cell biology.
To understand the signalling mechanisms.
Understand basic principles of molecular biology at intracellular level to regulate growth,
division and development.
TEXTBOOKS:
1. Cooper, G.M. and R.E. Hansman “The Cell: A Molecular Approach”, 8th Edition, Oxford
University Press, 2018
2. Friefelder, David. “Molecular Biology.” Narosa Publications, 1999
3. Weaver, Robert F. “Molecular Biology” IInd Edition, Tata McGraw-Hill, 2003.
REFERENCES:
1. Lodish H, Berk A, MatsudairaP,Kaiser CA, Krieger M, Schot MP, Zipursky L, Darnell J.
Molecular Cell Biology, 6th Edition, 2007.
2. Becker, W.M. etal., “The World of the Cell”, 9th Edition, Pearson Education, 2003.
280
3. Campbell, N.A., J.B. Recee and E.J. Simon “Essential Biology”, VIIrd Edition, Pearson
International, 2007.
4. Alberts, Bruce etal., “Essential Cell Biology”, 4th Edition, W.W. Norton, 2013.
OPEN ELECTIVE IV
UNIT I 9
Writing Skills – Essential Grammar and Vocabulary – Passive Voice, Reported Speech, Concord,
Signpost words, Cohesive Devices – Paragraph writing - Technical Writing vs. General Writing.
UNIT II 9
Project Report – Definition, Structure, Types of Reports, Purpose – Intended Audience –
Plagiarism – Report Writing in STEM fields – Experiment – Statistical Analysis.
UNIT III 9
Structure of the Project Report: (Part 1) Framing a Title – Content – Acknowledgement – Funding
Details -Abstract – Introduction – Aim of the Study – Background - Writing the research question -
Need of the Study/Project Significance, Relevance – Determining the feasibility – Theoretical
Framework.
UNIT IV 9
Structure of the Project Report: (Part 2) – Literature Review, Research Design, Methods of Data
Collection - Tools and Procedures - Data Analysis - Interpretation - Findings –Limitations -
Recommendations – Conclusion – Bibliography.
UNIT V 9
Proof reading a report – Avoiding Typographical Errors – Bibliography in required Format – Font –
Spacing – Checking Tables and Illustrations – Presenting a Report Orally – Techniques.
TOTAL:45 PERIODS
OUTCOMES
By the end of the course, learners will be able to
Write effective project reports.
Use statistical tools with confidence.
Explain the purpose and intension of the proposed project coherently and with
clarity.
Create writing texts to suit achieve the intended purpose.
Master the art of writing winning proposals and projects.
281
CO-PO & PSO MAPPING
CO PO PSO
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 2 1 1 1 1 3 2 2 3 3 3 3 - - -
2 2 2 2 1 1 1 2 1 2 3 2 3 - - -
3 2 2 3 3 2 3 2 2 2 3 2 3 - - -
4 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 - - -
5 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 - - -
AVg. 2.4 2.2 2.4 2.2 2 2.6 2.4 2.2 2.6 3 2.6 3 - - -
1-low, 2-medium, 3-high, ‘-“- no correlation
Note: The average value of this course to be used for program articulation matrix.
REFERENCES
1. Gerson and Gerson - Technical Communication: Process and Product, 7th Edition,
Prentice Hall(2012)
2. Virendra K. Pamecha - Guide to Project Reports, Project Appraisals and Project
Finance (2012)
3. Daniel Riordan - Technical Report Writing Today (1998)
Darla-Jean Weatherford - Technical Writing for Engineering Professionals (2016) Penwell
Publishers.
282
OUTCOMES
On completion of the course, the student will be able to apply appropriate management
techniques towards managing the water resources.
CO1 Describe the context and principles of IWRM; Compare the conventional and integrated
ways of water management.
CO2 Discuss on the different water uses; how it is impacted and ways to tackle these impacts.
CO3 Explain the economic aspects of water and choose the best economic option among the
alternatives; illustrate the pros and cons of PPP through case studies.
CO4 Illustrate the recent trends in water management.
CO5 Understand the implementation hitches and the institutional frameworks.
TEXT BOOKS
1. Cech Thomas V., Principles of water resources: history, development, management and policy.
John Wiley and Sons Inc., New York. 2003.
2. Mollinga P. et al. “ Integrated Water Resources Management”, Water in South Asia Volume I,
Sage Publications, 2006.
REFERENCES
1. Technical Advisory Committee, Background Papers No: 1, 4 and 7, Stockholm, Sweden.
2002.
2. IWRM Guidelines at River Basin Level (UNESCO, 2008).
3. Tutorial on Basic Principles of Integrated Water Resources Management ,CAP-NET.
http://www.pacificwater.org/userfiles/file/IWRM/Toolboxes/introduction%20to%20iwrm/Tutorial
_text.pdf
4. Pramod R. Bhave, 2011, Water Resources Systems, Narosa Publishers.
5. The 17 Goals, United Nations, https://sdgs.un.org/goals.
UNIT II INTERPOLATION 9
Central difference: Stirling and Bessel's interpolation formulae ; Piecewise spline interpolation:
Piecewise linear, piecewise quadratic and cubic spline ; Least square approximation for
continuous data (upto 3rd degree).
283
UNIT IV FINITE DIFFERENCE METHODS FOR ELLIPTIC EQUATIONS 9
Laplace and Poisson’s equations in a rectangular region : Five point finite difference schemes -
Leibmann’s iterative methods - Dirichlet's and Neumann conditions – Laplace equation in polar
coordinates : Finite difference schemes .
TEXT BOOKS :
1. Grewal, B.S., "Numerical Methods in Engineering & Science ", Khanna Publications,
Delhi, 2013.
2. Gupta, S.K., "Numerical Methods for Engineers", (Third Edition), New Age Publishers, 2015.
3. Jain, M.K., Iyengar, S.R.K. and Jain, R.K., "Computational Methods for Partial Differential
Equations", New Age Publishers, 1994.
REFERENCES:
1. Saumyen Guha and Rajesh Srivastava, "Numerical methods for Engineering and Science",
Oxford Higher Education, New Delhi, 2010.
2. Burden, R.L., and Faires, J.D., “Numerical Analysis – Theory and Applications”, 9 th Edition,
Cengage Learning, New Delhi, 2016.
3. Gupta S.K., “Numerical Methods for Engineers”,4th Edition, New Age Publishers, 2019.
4. Sastry, S.S., “Introductory Methods of Numerical Analysis”, 5th Edition, PHI Learning, 2015.
5. Morton, K.W. and Mayers D.F., "Numerical solution of Partial Differential equations",
Cambridge University press, Cambridge, 2002.
PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PS
01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 O1 O2 O3
CO1 3 3 3 3 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 3 - - -
CO2 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 1 1 1 3 - - -
CO3 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 1 1 1 3 - - -
CO4 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 1 1 1 3 - - -
CO5 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 1 1 1 3 - - -
Avg 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 1 1 1 1 3 - - -
284
OBJECTIVES:
To introduce the basic concepts of probability, one and two dimensional random variables
with applications to engineering which can describe real life phenomenon.
To understand the basic concepts of random processes which are widely used in
communication networks.
To acquaint with specialized random processes which are apt for modelling the real time
scenario.
To understand the concept of correlation and spectral densities.
To understand the significance of linear systems with random inputs.
TEXT BOOKS
1. Ibe, O.C.," Fundamentals of Applied Probability and Random Processes ", 1st Indian Reprint,
Elsevier, 2007.
2. Peebles, P.Z., "Probability, Random Variables and Random Signal Principles ", Tata McGraw
Hill, 4th Edition, New Delhi, 2002.
REFERENCES
1. Cooper. G.R., McGillem. C.D., "Probabilistic Methods of Signal and System Analysis", Oxford
University Press, New Delhi, 3rd Indian Edition, 2012.
2. Hwei Hsu, "Schaum’s Outline of Theory and Problems of Probability, Random
Variables and Random Processes ", Tata McGraw Hill Edition, New Delhi, 2004.
3. Miller. S.L. and Childers. D.G., “Probability and Random Processes with Applications to Signal
Processing and Communications ", Academic Press, 2004.
285
4. Stark. H. and Woods. J.W., “Probability and Random Processes with Applications to Signal
Processing ", Pearson Education, Asia, 3rd Edition, 2002.
5. Yates. R.D. and Goodman. D.J., “Probability and Stochastic Processes", Wiley India Pvt. Ltd.,
Bangalore, 2nd Edition, 2012.
PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PS
01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 O1 O2 O3
CO1 3 3 0 0 0 0 0 0 3 0 0 2 - - -
CO2 3 3 0 0 0 0 0 0 3 0 0 2 - - -
CO3 3 3 0 0 0 0 0 0 3 0 0 2 - - -
CO4 3 3 0 0 0 0 0 0 3 0 0 2 - - -
CO5 3 3 0 0 0 0 0 0 3 0 0 2 - - -
Avg 3 3 0 0 0 0 0 0 3 0 0 2 - - -
OMA357 QUEUEING AND RELIABILITY MODELLING LT P C
3 0 0 3
OBJECTIVES:
To provide necessary basic concepts in probability and random processes for
applications such as random signals, linear systems in communication engineering.
To understand the concept of queueing models and apply in engineering.
To provide the required mathematical support in real life problems and develop probabilistic
models which can be used in several areas of science and engineering.
To study the system reliability and hazard function for series and parallel systems.
To implement Markovian Techniques for availability and maintainability which opens up new
avenues for research.
TEXT BOOKS
1. Shortle J.F, Gross D, Thompson J.M,Harris C.M., “Fundamentals of Queueing Theory”, John
Wiley and Sons, New York,2018.
2. Balagurusamy E., “Reliability Engineering”, Tata McGraw Hill Publishing Company Ltd., New
Delhi,2010.
REFERENCES
1. Medhi J, ”Stochastic models of Queueing Theory”, Academic Press, Elsevier,
Amsterdam, 2003.
2. Taha, H.A., "Operations Research", 9th Edition, Pearson India Education Services, Delhi,
2016.
3. Trivedi, K.S., "Probability and Statistics with Reliability, Queueing and Computer Science
Applications", 2nd Edition, John Wiley and Sons, 2002.
4. Govil A.K., “Reliability Engineering”, Tata-McGraw Hill Publishing Company Ltd.,
New Delhi,1983.
PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PO PS PS PS
01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 O1 O2 O3
CO1 3 3 0 0 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2 - - -
CO2 3 3 2 0 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2 - - -
CO3 3 3 0 2 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2 - - -
CO4 3 3 2 0 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2 - - -
CO5 3 3 3 2 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2 - - -
Avg 3 3 1.4 0.8 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 2 - - -
REFERENCES
1. Mikell P. Groover, Automation, Production Systems, and Computer-Integrated Manufacturing,
Pearson, 2007.
2. Amitabh Raturi, Production and Inventory Management, , 2008.
3. Adam Jr. Ebert, Production and Operations Management, PHI Publication, 1992.
4. Muhlemann, Okland and Lockyer, Production and Operation Management, Macmillan
India,1992.
6. Chary S.N, Production and Operations Management, TMH Publications, 2010.
7. Terry Hill ,Operation Management. Pal Grave McMillan (Case Study).2005.
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
288
Uni-variate, Bi-variate and Multi-variate techniques – Classification of multivariate techniques –
Guidelines for multivariate analysis and interpretation.
REFERENCES :
1. Joseph F Hair, Rolph E Anderson, Ronald L. Tatham & William C. Black, Multivariate Data
Analysis, Pearson Education, New Delhi, 2005.
2. Barbara G. Tabachnick, Linda S.Fidell, Using Multivariate Statistics, 6th Edition, Pearson, 2012.
3. Richard A Johnson and Dean W.Wichern, Applied Multivariate Statistical Analysis, Prentice
Hall, New Delhi, 2005.
4. David R Anderson, Dennis J Seveency, and Thomas A Williams, Statistics for Business and
Economics, Thompson, Singapore, 2002
289
To gain knowledge on applications of direct energy deposition, and material jetting
processes.
To impart knowledge on sheet lamination and direct write technologies.
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Overview - Need - Development of Additive Manufacturing (AM) Technology: Rapid Prototyping-
Rapid Tooling - Rapid Manufacturing - Additive Manufacturing. AM Process Chain - ASTM/ISO
52900 Classification - Benefits - AM Unique Capabilities - AM File formats: STL, AMF Applications:
Building Printing, Bio Printing, Food Printing, Electronics Printing, Automobile, Aerospace,
Healthcare. Business Opportunities in AM.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Ian Gibson, David Rosen, Brent Stucker, Mahyar Khorasani “Additive manufacturing
technologies”. 3rd edition Springer Cham, Switzerland. (2021). ISBN: 978-3-030-56126-0
2. Andreas Gebhardt and Jan-Steffen Hötter “Additive Manufacturing: 3D Printing for
Prototyping and Manufacturing”, Hanser publications, United States, 2015, ISBN: 978-1-
56990-582-1.
290
REFERENCES:
1. Andreas Gebhardt, “Understanding Additive Manufacturing: Rapid Prototyping, Rapid
Manufacturing”, Hanser Gardner Publication, Cincinnati., Ohio, 2011, ISBN
:9783446425521.
2. Milan Brandt, “Laser Additive Manufacturing: Materials, Design, Technologies, and
Applications”, Woodhead Publishing., United Kingdom, 2016, ISBN: 9780081004333.
3. Amit Bandyopadhyay and Susmita Bose, “Additive Manufacturing”, 1st Edition, CRC Press.,
United States, 2015, ISBN-13: 978-1482223590.
4. Kamrani A.K. and Nasr E.A., “Rapid Prototyping: Theory and practice”, Springer., United
States ,2006, ISBN: 978-1-4614-9842-1.
5. Liou, L.W. and Liou, F.W., “Rapid Prototyping and Engineering applications: A tool box for
prototype development”, CRC Press., United States, 2011, ISBN: 9780849334092.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Product Development – Sten Jonsson
2. Product Design & Development – Karl T. Ulrich, Maria C. Young, Steven D. Eppinger
REFERENCES:
1. Revolutionizing Product Development – Steven C Wheelwright & Kim B. Clark
2. Change by Design
3. Toyota Product Development System – James Morgan & Jeffrey K. Liker
4. Winning at New Products – Robert Brands 3rd Edition
5. Product Design & Value Engineering – Dr. M.A. Bulsara &Dr. H.R. Thakkar
PO PSO
CO
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 1 1 3 1 1 1 1 1 3 2
2 1 1 3 1 1 1 1 1 3 2
3 1 1 3 1 1 1 1 1 3 2
4 1 1 3 1 1 1 1 1 3 2
5 1 1 3 1 1 1 1 1 3 2
Low (1) ; Medium (2) ; High (3)
292
UNIT I UI/UX 9
Fundamental concepts in UI & UX - Tools - Fundamentals of design principles - Psychology and
Human Factors for User Interface Design - Layout and composition for Web, Mobile and
Devices - Typography - Information architecture - Color theory - Design process flow, wireframes,
best practices in the industry -User engagement ethics - Design alternatives
TEXT BOOKS
1. Peter Fiell, Charlotte Fiell, Industrial Design A-Z, TASCHEN America Llc(2003)
2. Samar Malik, Autodesk Fusion 360 - The Master Guide.
3. Steve Krug, Don't Make Me Think, Revisited: A Common Sense Approach to Web Usability,
Pearson,3rd edition(2014)
REFERENCES
1. https://www.adobe.com/products/xd/learn/get-star ted.html
2. https://developer.android.com/guide
3. https://help.autodesk.com/view/fusion360/ENU/courses/
4. https://help.prusa3d.com/en/categor y/prusaslicer_204
293
MF3010 MICRO AND PRECISION ENGINEERING LT P C
3003
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
At the end of this course the student should be able to
Learn about the precision machine tools
Learn about the macro and micro components.
Understand handling and operating of the precision machine tools.
Learn to work with miniature models of existing machine tools/robots and other
instruments.
Learn metrology for micro system
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Davim, J. Paulo, ed. Microfabrication and Precision Engineering: Research and
Development. Woodhead Publishing, 2017
2. Gupta K, editor. Micro and Precision Manufacturing. Springer; 2017
REFERENCES:
1. Dornfeld, D., and Lee, D. E., Precision Manufacturing, 2008, Springer.
2. H. Nakazawa, Principles of Precision Engineering, 1994, Oxford University Press.
3. Whitehouse, D. J., Handbook of Surface Metrology, Institute of Physics Publishing,
294
Philadelphia PA, 1994.
4. Murthy.R.L, ―Precision Engineering in Manufacturing‖, New Age International,
New Delhi, 2005
TEXT BOOKS:
1. John M. Nicholas, Herman Steyn Project Management for Engineering, Business
and Technology, Taylor & Francis, 2 August 2020, ISBN: 9781000092561.
2. Albert Lester ,Project Management, Planning and Control, Elsevier/Butterworth-
Heinemann, 2007, ISBN: 9780750669566, 075066956X.
REFERENCES:
1. Ashish K. Bhattacharya, Principles & Practices of Cost Accounting A. H. Wheeler
publisher, 1991.
2. Charles T. Horngren and George Foster, Advanced Management Accounting,
1988.
3. Charles T. Horngren et al Cost Accounting a Managerial Emphasis, Prentice Hall of
India, New Delhi, 2011.
4. Robert S Kaplan Anthony A. Alkinson, Management & Cost Accounting, 2003.
5. Vohra N.D., Quantitative Techniques in Management, Tata McGraw Hill Book Co.
Ltd, 2007.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Doebelin's Measurement Systems: 7th Edition (SIE),Ernest O. Doebelin DhaneshN.Manik
McGraw Hill Publishers, 2019.
2. Robert Brandy, “ Automotive Electronics and Computer System”, Prentice Hall,2001
3. William Kimberley,” Bosch Automotive Handbook”, 6th Edition, Robert Bosch GmbH, 2004.
4. Bosch Automotive Electrics and Automotive Electronics Systems and Components,
Networking and Hybrid Drive, 5th Edition, 2007, ISBN No: 978‐3‐658‐01783‐5.
REFERENCES:
1. James D Halderman, “ Automotive Electrical and Electronics” , Prentice Hall, USA, 2013
2. Tom Denton, “Automotive Electrical and Electronics Systems,” Third Edition, 2004, SAE
International.
3. Patranabis.D, “ Sensors and Transducers”, 2nd Edition, Prentice Hall India Ltd,2003
4. William Ribbens, "Understanding Automotive Electronics ‐An Engineering Perspective," 7th
Edition, Elsevier Butterworth‐Heinemann Publishers, 2012.
298
UNIT IV THRUST VECTOR CONTROL 9
TVC Mechanisms with a Single Nozzle – TVC with Multiple Thrust Chambers or Nozzles – Testing
– Integration with Vehicle – SITVC method – other jet control methods - exhaust plume problems
in space environment
PO’s PSO’s
CO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 3
2 3 2 3 3 2 3 2 2
3 3 3 2 2 3 2 2 2
4 3 3 3 2 3 2 3 3
5 3 2 3 3 2 3 3 2 1
AVg. 3 2.6 2.8 2.6 2.6 2.6 2.4 2 2 2.5
TEXTBOOKS:
1. KanishkaBedi, Production and Operations Management,OxfordUniversityPress,2007.
2. Stoner,Freeman,Gilbert, Management,6th Ed, PearsonEducation,NewDelhi,2004.
3. ThomasN.Duening & John M.Ivancevich Management Principles and Guidelines,
Biztantra,2007.
4. P.VijayKumar,N.Appa Rao and Ashnab, Chnalill, CengageLearning India,2012.
REFERECES:
1. KotlerPhilip and KellerKevinLane: Marketing Management, Pearson, 2012.
2. KoontzandWeihrich: Essentials of Management, McGrawHill, 2012.
3. Lawrence RJauch,R.Guptaand William F. Glueck: Business Policy and Strategic
Management Science,McGrawHill,2012.
4. SamuelC.Certo:Modern Management,2012.
300
OIM353 PRODUCTION PLANNING AND CONTROL L T P C
3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES:
To understand the concept of production planning and control act work study,
To apply the concept of product planning,
To analyze the production scheduling,
To apply the Inventory Control concepts.
To prepare the manufacturing requirement Planning (MRP II) and Enterprise
Resource Planning (ERP).
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Objectives and benefits of planning and control-Functions of production control-Types of
production- job- batch and continuous-Product development and design-Marketing aspect -
Functional aspects- Operational aspect-Durability and dependability aspect aesthetic aspect. Profit
consideration- Standardization, Simplification & specialization- Break even analysis-Economics of
a new design.
TEXT BOOKS:
301
1. James. B. Dilworth, ”Operations management – Design, Planning and Control for
manufacturing and services” Mcgraw Hill International edition 1992.
2. Martand Telsang, “Industrial Engineering and Production Management”, First edition, S.
Chand and Company, 2000.
REFERENCES
1. Chary. S.N., “Theory and Problems in Production & Operations Management”, Tata
McGraw Hill, 1995.
2. Elwood S.Buffa, and Rakesh K.Sarin, “Modern Production / Operations Management”,
8th Edition John Wiley and Sons, 2000
3. Jain. K.C. & Aggarwal. L.N., “Production Planning Control and Industrial Management”,
Khanna Publishers, 1990
4. Kanishka Bedi, “Production and Operations management”, 2nd Edition, Oxford
university press, 2007.
5. Melynk, Denzler, “ Operations management – A value driven approach” Irwin Mcgraw
hill.
6. Norman Gaither, G. Frazier, “Operations Management” 9th Edition, Thomson learning
IE, 2007
7. Samson Eilon, “Elements of Production Planning and Control”, Universal Book
Corpn.1984
8. Upendra Kachru, “ Production and Operations Management – Text and cases” 1st
Edition, Excel books 2007
PO’s PSO’s
CO’s
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
1 3 3 3 1 1 3
2 3 2 3 2
3 2 3 2
4 2 2
5 3 3 2 1
AVg. 3 2.6 2 3 1 1 3 1.8
TEXT BOOKS
1. Richard B. Chase, Ravi Shankar, F. Robert Jacobs, Nicholas J. Aquilano,
Operations andSupply Management, Tata McGraw Hill, 12th Edition, 2010.
2. Norman Gaither and Gregory Frazier, Operations Management, South Western
CengageLearning, 2002.
303
REFERENCES
1. William J Stevenson, Operations Management, Tata McGraw Hill, 9th Edition, 2009.
2. Russel and Taylor, Operations Management, Wiley, Fifth Edition, 2006.
3. Kanishka Bedi, Production and Operations Management, Oxford University Press, 2004.
4. Chary S. N, Production and Operations Management, Tata McGraw Hill, Third Edition,
2008.
5. Aswathappa K and Shridhara Bhat K, Production and Operations Management,
Himalaya Publishing House, Revised Second Edition, 2008.
6. Mahadevan B, Operations Management Theory and practice, Pearson Education, 2007.
7. Pannerselvam R, Production and Operations Management, Prentice Hall India, Second
Edition, 2008.
304
i. Radiation: Types and effects of radiation on human body, Measurement and detection of
radiation intensity. Effects of radiation on human body, Measurement – disposal of radioactive
waste, Control of radiation ii. Noise and Vibration: Sources, and its control, Effects of noise on the
auditory system and health, Measurement of noise , Different air pollutants in industries, Effect of
different gases and particulate matter ,acid fumes ,smoke, fog on human health, Vibration: effects.
TOTAL PERIODS: 45
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Students able to
CO1: Explain and apply human factors engineering concepts in both evaluation of existing
systems and design of new systems
CO2: Specify designs that avoid occupation related injuries
CO3: Define and apply the principles of work design, motion economy, and work environment
design.
CO4: Identify the basic human sensory, cognitive, and physical capabilities and limitations with
respect to human-machine system performance.
CO5: Acknowledge the impact of workplace design and environment on productivity
TEXT BOOKS:
1. R. K. Jain and Sunil S. Rao , Industrial Safety , Health and Environment Management Systems,
Khanna publishers, New Delhi (2006)
2. Slote. L, Handbook of Occupational Safety and Health, John Willey and Sons, New York .
REFERENCES:
1. Jeanne MagerStellman, Encyclopedia of Occupational Health and Safety (ILO) Ms. Irma
Jourdan publication
2. Frank P Lees - Loss of prevention in Process Industries, Vol. 1 and 2,
3. ButterworthHeinemann Ltd., London (1991). 2. Industrial Safety - National Safety Council of
India
4. Frank P Lees – Loss of prevention in Process Industries , Vol. 1 and 2, Butterworth- Heinemann
Ltd., London
5. R. K. Jain and Sunil S. Rao, Industrial Safety , Health and Environment Management Systems,
Khanna publishers, New Delhi (2006).
305
OSF353 CHEMICAL PROCESS SAFETY L T P C
3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES
Teach the principles of safety applicable to the design, and operation of chemical process
plants.
Ensure that potential hazards are identified and mitigation measures are in place to prevent
unwanted release of energy.
Learn about the hazardous chemicals into locations that could expose employees and others
to serious harm.
Focuses on preventing incidents and accidents during large scale manufacturing of
chemicals and pharmaceuticals.
Ensure that the general design of the plant is capable of complying with the dose limits in
force and with the radioactive releases.
306
CO3Apply the principles of safety in the storage and handling of gases.
CO4Identify the conditions that lead to reaction hazards and adopt measures to prevent them.
CO5Develop thorough knowledge about
TEXT BOOK
1 David A Crowl& Joseph F Louvar,”Chemical Process safety”, Pearson publication, 3rd
Edition,2014
2 Maurice Jones .A,”Fire Protection Systems,2nd edition, Jones & Bartlett Publishers,2015
REFERENCES:
1. Ralph King and Ron Hirst,”King´s safety in the process industries”, Arnold, London, 1998.
2. Industrial Environment and its Evolution and Control, NIOSH Publication, 1973.
3. National Safety Council,” Accident prevention manual for industrial operations”. Chicago,
1982.
4. Lewis, Richard. J., Sr,“Sax´s dangerous properties of materials”. (Ninth edition). Van
Nostrand Reinhold, New York, 1996.
5. Roy E Sanders, ”Chemical Process Safety”,3rd Edition, Gulf professional publishing, 2006
307
Classification of magnetic materials, spontaneous magnetization in ferromagnetic materials,
magnetic Anisotropy, Magnetostriction, diamagnetism, magnetically soft and hard materials,
special purpose materials, feebly magnetic materials, Ferrites, cast and cermet permanent
magnets, ageing of magnets. Factors effecting permeability and Hysteresis
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Pradeep Fulay, “Electronic, Magnetic and Optical materials”, CRC Press, taylor and
Francis, 2 nd illustrated edition, 2017.
2. “R K Rajput”, “A course in Electrical Engineering Materials”, Laxmi Publications, 2009.
REFERENCE BOOKS:
1. T K Basak, “A course in Electrical Engineering Materials”, New Age Science
Publications, 2009
2. TTTI Madras, “Electrical Engineering Materials”, McGraw Hill Education, 2004.
3. Adrianus J. Dekker, “Electrical Engineering Materials”, PHI Publication, 2006.
4. S. P. Seth, P. V. Gupta “A course in Electrical Engineering Materials”, Dhanpat Rai &
amp; Sons, 2011.
5. C. Kittel, “Introduction to Solid State Physics”, 7th Edition, John Wiley &
Sons,Singapore, (2006).
PO1 PSO PSO PSO
PO1 PO2 PO3 PO4 PO5 PO6 PO7 PO8 PO9 PO11 PO12
0 1 2 3
C01 3 2 2 3 2 2 2 1
308
C02 3 1 2 2 2 2 2 1
C03 3 2 1 2 2 2 2 1
CO4 3 2 1 2 2 2 2 2
CO5 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 1
Avg 3 1.8 1.6 2.2 2 2 2 1.2
UNIT I NANOMATERIALS 9
Introduction, Classification: 0D, 1D, 2D, 3D nanomaterials and nano-composites, their mechanical,
electrical, optical, magnetic properties; Nanomaterials versus bulk materials.
UNIT V APPLICATIONS 9
Applications of nanoparticles, quantum dots, nanotubes, nanowires, nanocoatings; applications in
electronic, electrical and medical industries
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
After completion of this course, the students will be able to
1. Evaluate nanomaterials and understand the different types of nanomaterials
2. Recognise the effects of dimensionality of materials on the properties
3. Process different nanomaterials and use them in engineering applications
309
4. Use appropriate techniques for characterising nanomaterials
5. Identify and use different nanomaterials for applications in different engineering
fields.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Bhusan, Bharat (Ed), “Springer Handbook of Nanotechnology”, 2nd edition, 2007.
2. Carl C. Koch (ed.), NANOSTRUCTURED MATERIALS, Processing, Properties and Potential
Applications, NOYES PUBLICATIONS, Norwich, New York, U.S.A.
REFERENCES:
1. Poole C.P, and Owens F.J., Introduction to Nanotechnology, John Wiley 2003
2. Nalwa H.S., Encyclopedia of Nanoscience and Nanotechnology, American Scientific
Publishers 2004
3. Zehetbauer M.J. and Zhu Y.T., Bulk Nanostructured Materials, Wiley 2008
4. Wang Z.L., Characterization of Nanophase Materials, Wiley 2000
5. Gutkin Y., Ovid’ko I.A. and Gutkin M., Plastic Deformation in Nanocrystalline Materials,
Springer 2004
310
valves – Types, Construction and Operation – Servo and Proportional valves – Applications –
Accessories : Reservoirs, Pressure Switches – Applications – Fluid Power ANSI Symbols –
Problems.
TEXT BOOKS
1. Anthony Esposito, “Fluid Power with Applications”, Prentice Hall, 2009.
2. James A. Sullivan, “Fluid Power Theory and Applications”, Fourth Edition, Prentice
Hall,1997.
REFERENCES
1. Shanmugasundaram.K, “Hydraulic and Pneumatic Controls”. Chand & Co, 2006.
2. Majumdar, S.R., “Oil Hydraulics Systems – Principles and Maintenance”, Tata McG
Raw Hill, 2001.
311
3. Majumdar, S.R., “Pneumatic Systems – Principles and Maintenance”, Tata McGRaw
Hill, 2007.
4. Dudley, A. Pease and John J Pippenger, “Basic Fluid Power”, Prentice Hall, 1987
5. Srinivasan. R, “Hydraulic and Pneumatic Controls”, Vijay Nicole Imprints, 2008
6. Joshi.P, Pneumatic Control”, Wiley India, 2008.
7. Jagadeesha T, “Pneumatics Concepts, Design and Applications “, Universities Press,
2015.
TEXT BOOKS
1. Bolton W., “Mechatronics”, Pearson Education, 6th Edition, 2015.
2. Ramesh S Gaonkar, “Microprocessor Architecture, Programming, and Applications with the
8085”, Penram International Publishing Private Limited, 6th Edition, 2013.
REFERENCES
1. Bradley D.A., Dawson D., Buru N.C. and Loader A.J., “Mechatronics”, Chapman and Hall,
1993.
2. Davis G. Alciatore and Michael B. Histand, “Introduction to Mechatronics and Measurement
systems”, McGraw Hill Education, 2011.
3. Devadas Shetty and Richard A. Kolk, “Mechatronics Systems Design”, Cengage Learning,
2010.
4. Nitaigour Premchand Mahalik, “Mechatronics Principles, Concepts and Applications”,
McGraw Hill Education, 2015.
5. Smaili. A and Mrad. F, “Mechatronics Integrated Technologies for Intelligent Machines”,
Oxford University Press, 2007.
313
ORA352 CONCEPTS IN MOBILE ROBOTS L T P C
3 0 0 3
COURSE OBJECTIVES
1. To introduce mobile robotic technology and its types in detail.
2. To learn the kinematics of wheeled and legged robot.
3. To familiarize the intelligence into the mobile robots using various sensors.
4. To acquaint the localization strategies and mapping technique for mobile robot.
5. To aware the collaborative mobile robotics in task planning, navigation and intelligence.
UNIT – II KINEMATICS 9
Kinematic Models – Representation of Robot – Forward Kinematics – Wheel and Robot
Constraints – Degree of Mobility and Steerability – Manoeuvrability – Workspace – Degrees of
Freedom – Path and Trajectory Considerations – Motion Controls - Holonomic Robots
UNIT – IV LOCALIZATION 9
Localization Based Navigation Versus Programmed Solutions - Map Representation -
Continuous Representations - Decomposition Strategies - Probabilistic Map-Based Localization
- Landmark-Based Navigation - Globally Unique Localization - Positioning Beacon Systems -
Route-Based Localization - Autonomous Map Building - Simultaneous Localization and
Mapping (SLAM).
UNIT – V PLANNING, NAVIGATION AND COLLABORATIVE ROBOTS 9
Introduction - Competences for Navigation: Planning and Reacting - Path Planning - Obstacle
Avoidance - Navigation Architectures - Control Localization - Techniques for Decomposition -
Case Studies – Collaborative Robots – Swarm Robots.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of this course, the students will be able to:
CO1: Evaluate the appropriate mobile robots for the desired application.
CO2: Create the kinematics for given wheeled and legged robot.
CO3:Analyse the sensors for the intelligence of mobile robotics.
CO4: Create the localization strategies and mapping technique for mobile robot.
CO5: Create the collaborative mobile robotics for planning, navigation and intelligence for
desired applications.
TEXTBOOK
1. Roland Siegwart and IllahR.Nourbakish, “Introduction to Autonomous Mobile Robots” MIT
Press, Cambridge, 2004.
REFERENCES:
1. Dragomir N. Nenchev, Atsushi Konno, TeppeiTsujita, “Humanoid Robots: Modelling and
Control”, Butterworth-Heinemann, 2018
314
2. MohantaJagadish Chandra, “Introduction to Mobile Robots Navigation”, LAP Lambert
Academic Publishing, 2015.
3. Peter Corke, “Robotics, Vision and Control”, Springer, 2017.
4. Ulrich Nehmzow, “Mobile Robotics: A Practical Introduction”, Springer, 2003.
5. Xiao Qi Chen, Y.Q. Chen and J.G. Chase, “Mobile Robots - State of the Art in Land, Sea,
Air, and Collaborative Missions”, Intec Press, 2009.
6. Alonzo Kelly, Mobile Robotics: Mathematics, Models, and Methods, Cambridge University
Press, 2013, ISBN: 978-1107031159.
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon successful completion of the course, students should be able to:
315
CO1: Explain the basics of propulsion system and ship dynamic movements
CO2: Familiarize with various components assisting ship stabilization.
CO3: Demonstrate the performance of the ship.
CO4: Classify the Propeller and its types, Materials etc.
CO5: Categories the Rudder and its types, design criteria of rudder.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. GP. Ghose, “Basic Ship propulsion”,2015
2. E.A. Stokoe “Reeds Ship construction for marine engineers”, Vol. 5,2010
3. E.A. Stokoe, “Reeds Naval architecture for the marine engineers”,4th Edition,2009
REFERENCES BOOKS:
1. DJ Eyers and GJ Bruse, “Ship Construction”, 7th Edition, 2006.
2. KJ Rawson and EC Tupper, “Basic Ship theory I” Vol. 1,5th Edition,2001.
C PO PSO
O PO P P P P P P P P PO PO PO PS PS PS PS
1 O2 O3 O4 O5 O6 O7 O8 O9 10 11 12 O1 O2 O3 O4
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
2 1 1 1 1 1
3 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
4 1 1 1 1 1
5 1 1 1 1 1
Av 5/5 2/2 4/4 4/4 2/2 1/1 1/1 2/2 1/1 1/1 5/5 5/5
g =1 =1 =1 =1 =1 =1 =1 =1 =1 =1 =1 =1
316
Aluminium alloy sandwich panels, Fire protection especially for Aluminium Alloys, Fiber Reinforced
Composites
OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of this course, students would
1. Acquire Knowledge on floatation of ships
2. Acquire Knowledge on features of various ships
3. Acquire Knowledge of Shipbuilding Materials
4. Acquire Knowledge to identify the different types of marine propeller
and rudder
5. Understand the Roles and responsibilities of governing bodies
TEXT BOOKS:
1. D.J.Eyres, “Ship Constructions”, Seventh Edition, Butter Worth Heinemann Publishing,
USA,2015
2. Dr.DA Taylor, “Merchant Ship Naval Architecture” I. Mar EST publications, 2006
3. EA Stokoe, E.A, “Naval Architecture for Marine Engineers”, Vol.4, Reeds Publications,2000
REFERENCES:
1. Kemp & Young “Ship Construction Sketches & Notes”, Butter Worth Heinemann
Publishing,USA, 2011
2. MARPOL Consolidated Edition , Bhandakar Publications, 2018
3. SOLAS Consolidated Edition , Bhandakar Publications, 2016
317
Marine Engineering Terminologies, Parts of Ship, Introduction to Machinery systems on board
ships – Propulsion Machinery system, Electricity Generator system, Steering gear system, Air
compressors & Air reservoirs, Fuel oil and Lubricating Oil Purifiers, Marine Boiler systems
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Taylor, “Introduction to Marine engineering”, Revised Second Edition, Butterworth
Heinemann, London, 2011
2. J.K.Dhar, “Basic Marine Engineering”, Tenth Edition, G-Maritime Publications, Mumbai, 2011
3. K.Ramaraj, “ Text book on Marine Engineering”, Eswar Press, Chennai, 2018
REFERENCES:
1. Alan L.Rowen, “Introduction to Practical Marine Engineering, Volume 1&2, The Institute of
Marine Engineers (India), Mumbai, 2006
2. A.S.Tambwekar, “Naval Architecture and Ship Construction”, The Institute of Marine
Engineers (India), Mumbai, 2015
CO-PO MAPPING:
Mapping of COs with POs and PSOs
COs/Pos&P POs PSOs
SOs 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3
CO1 1 2 3 1 3 2 1 2 1 3
CO2 1 2 3 1 3 2 1 2 1 3
CO3 1 2 3 1 3 2 1 2 1 3
CO4 1 2 3 1 3 2 1 2 1 3
CO5 1 2 3 1 3 2 1 2 1 3
319
CO/PO & 1 2 3 1 3 2 1 2 1 3
PSO
Average
1 – Slight, 2 – Moderate, 3 – Substantial
TEXT BOOKS
1. Daniel Tal and John Altschuld, “Drone Technology in Architecture, Engineering and
Construction: A Strategic Guide to Unmanned Aerial Vehicle Operation and
Implementation”, 2021 John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
2. Terry Kilby and Belinda Kilby, “Make:Getting Started with Drones “,Maker Media, Inc,
2016
REFERENCES
1. John Baichtal, “Building Your Own Drones: A Beginners' Guide to Drones, UAVs, and
ROVs”, Que Publishing, 2016
2. Zavrsnik, “Drones and Unmanned Aerial Systems: Legal and Social Implications for
Security and Surveillance”, Springer, 2018.
320
On completion of the course, the student is expected to
CO1 Have basic idea about the fundamentals of GIS.
CO2 Understand the types of data models.
CO3 Get knowledge about data input and topology
CO4 Gain knowledge on data quality and standards
CO5 Understand data management functions and data output
TEXTBOOKS:
1. Kang - Tsung Chang, Introduction to Geographic Information Systems, McGraw Hill
Publishing, 2nd Edition, 2011.
2. Ian Heywood, Sarah Cornelius, Steve Carver, Srinivasa Raju, “An Introduction
Geographical Information Systems, Pearson Education, 2nd Edition,2007.
REFERENCES:
1. Lo. C. P., Albert K.W. Yeung, Concepts and Techniques of Geographic Information
Systems, Prentice-Hall India Publishers, 2006
TEXT BOOKS
1. Joseph L. Massie, 1995, “Essentials of Management”, prentice Hall of India Pvt
limited, New Delhi
2. Khanka S, 1999, Entrepreneurial Development, S, Chand and Co, New Delhi
3. Mohanty S K, 2007, Fundamentals of Entrepreneurship, Prentice Hall India, New
Delhi.
322
REFERENCES
1. Harih S B, Conner U J and Schwab G D, 1981, Management of the Farm Business,
Prentice Hall Inc, New Jersey
2. Omri Ralins, N.1980, Introduction to Agricultural: Prentice Hall Inc, New Jersey
3. Gittenger Price, 1989, Economic Analysis of Agricultural project, John Hopkins
University, Press, London.
4. Thomas W Zimmer and Norman M Scarborough, 1996, Entrepreneurship, Prentice
Hall, New Jersey.
5. Mar J Dollinger, 1999, Entrepreneurship strategies and resources, Prentice –Hall,
Upper Saddal Rover, New Jersey.
CO-PO MAPPING
323
OEN352 BIODIVERSITY CONSERVATION LTPC
3 003
OBJECTIVE:
The identification of different aspects of biological diversity and conservation techniques.
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Concept of Species, Variation; Introduction to Major Plant Groups; Evolutionary relationships
between Plant Groups; Nomenclature and History of plant taxonomy; Systems of Classification
and their Application; Study of Plant Groups; Study of Identification Characters; Study of important
families of Angiosperms; Plant Diversity Application.
REFERENCES:
1. Ecological Census Technique: A Handbook, Cambridge University Press, Sutherland, W.
2. Encyclopedia of Biodiversity, Academic Press, Simonson Asher Levin.
OUTCOMES
Upon successful completion of this course, students will:
CO1: An insight into the structure and function of diversity for ecosystem stability.
CO2: Understand the concept of animal diversity and taxonomy
CO3: Understand socio-economic issues pertaining to biodiversity
CO4: An understanding of biodiversity in community resource management.
324
CO5: Student can apply fundamental knowledge of biodiversity conservation to solve problems
associated with infrastructure development.
325
OEE353 INTRODUCTION TO CONTROL SYSTEMS LTPC
30 03
OBJECTIVES
To impart knowledge on various representations of systems.
To familiarize time response analysis of LTI systems and steady state error.
To analyze the frequency responses and stability of the systems
To analyze the stability of linear systems in frequency domain and time domain
To develop linear models mainly state variable model and transfer function model
TEXTBOOKS
1. Farid Golnarghi , Benjamin C. Kuo, Automatic Control Systems Paper back McGraw Hill
Education, 2018.
2. Katsuhiko Ogata, ‘Modern Control Engineering’, Pearson, 5th Edition2015.
3. J. Nagrath and M. Gopal, Control Systems Engineering (Multi Colour Edition), New Age
International, 2018.
REFERENCES
1. Richard C. Dorf and Robert H. Bishop, Modern Control Systems, Pearson Education, 2010.
2. Control System Dynamics" by Robert Clark, Cambridge University Press, 1996 USA.
3. John J. D’Azzo, Constantine H. Houpis and Stuart N. Sheldon, Linear Control System
AnalysisandDesign, 5th Edition, CRC PRESS, 2003.
4. S. Palani, Control System Engineering, McGraw-Hill Education Private Limited, 2009.
5. Yaduvir Singh and S.Janardhanan, Modern Control, Cengage Learning, First
326
Impression2010.
PO1 PO2 PO3 PO4 PO5 PO6 PO7 PO8 PO9 PO10 PO11 PO12 PSO1 PSO2 PSO3
CO1 3 3 3 2 2 2 3 3 3
CO2 3 3 2 3 1 3 3 3
CO3 3 3 3 2 2 3 3 3
CO4 3 3 3 2 2 2 3 3 3
CO5 3 3 3 1 1 1 3 3 3
3 3 3
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Automation overview, Requirement of automation systems, Architecture of Industrial Automation
system, Introduction of PLC and supervisory control and data acquisition (SCADA). Industrial bus
systems : Modbus & Profibus
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Students able to
CO1 Design a signal conditioning circuits for various application (L3).
CO2 Acquire a detail knowledge on data acquisition system interface and DCS system (L2).
CO3 Understand the basics and Importance of communication buses in applied automation
Engineering (L2).
CO4 Ability to design PLC Programmes by Applying Timer/Counter and Arithmetic and Logic
Instructions Studied for Ladder Logic and Function BIock.(L3)
CO5 Able to develop a PLC logic for a specific application on real world problem. (L5)
TEXT BOOKS:
1. S.K.Singh, “Industrial Instrumentation”, Tata Mcgraw Hill, 2nd edition companies,2003.
2. C D Johnson, “Process Control Instrumentation Technology”, Prentice Hall India,8th Edition,
2006.
3. E.A.Parr, Newnes ,NewDelhi,“Industrial Control Handbook”,3rd Edition, 2000.
REFERENCES:
1. John W. Webb and Ronald A. Reis, “Programmable Logic Controllers: Principles and
Applications”, 5th Edition, Prentice Hall Inc., New Jersey, 2003.
2. Frank D. Petruzella, “Programmable Logic Controllers”, 5th Edition, McGraw- Hill, New
York, 2016.
3. Krishna Kant, “Computer - Based Industrial Control”, 2nd Edition, Prentice Hall, New Delhi,
2011.
4. Gary Dunning, Thomson Delmar,“Programmable Logic Controller”, CeneageLearning, 3 rd
Edition,2005.
List of Open Source Software/ Learning website:
1. https://archive.nptel.ac.in/courses/108/105/108105062/
2. https://nptel.ac.in/courses/108105063
3. https://www.electrical4u.com/industrial-automation/
4. https://realpars.com/what-is-industrial-automation/
5. https://automationforum.co/what-is-industrial-automation-2/
328
OFD354 FUNDAMENTALS OF FOOD ENGINEERING LTPC
3003
OBJECTIVES
The course aims to
acquaint and equip the students with different techniques of measurement of engineering
properties.
make the students understand the nature of food constituents in the design of processing
equipment
UNIT I 9
Engineering properties of food materials: physical, thermal, aerodynamic, mechanical, optical and
electromagnetic properties.
UNIT II 9
Drying and dehydration: Basic drying theory, heat and mass transfer in drying, drying rate curves,
calculation of drying times, dryer efficiencies; classification and selection of dryers; tray, vacuum,
osmotic, fluidized bed, pneumatic, rotary, tunnel, trough, bin, belt, microwave, IR, heat pump and
freeze dryers; dryers for liquid: Drum or roller dryer, spray dryer and foammat dryers
UNIT III 9
Size reduction: Benefits, classification, determination and designation of the fineness of ground
material, sieve/screen analysis, principle and mechanisms of comminution of food, Rittinger’s,
Kick’s and Bond’s equations, work index, energy utilization; Size reduction equipment: Principal
types, crushers (jaw crushers, gyratory, smooth roll), hammer mills and impactors, attrition mills,
buhr mill, tumbling mills, tumbling mills, ultra fine grinders, fluid jet pulverizer, colloid mill, cutting
machines (slicing, dicing, shredding, pulping)
UNIT IV 9
Mixing: theory of solids mixing, criteria of mixer effectiveness and mixing indices, rate of mixing,
theory of liquid mixing, power requirement for liquids mixing; Mixing equipment: Mixers for lo.w- or
medium-viscosity liquids (paddle agitators, impeller agitators, powder-liquid contacting devices,
other mixers), mixers for high viscosity liquids and pastes, mixers for dry powders and particulate
solids.
UNIT V 9
Mechanical Separations: Theory, centrifugation, liquid-liquid centrifugation, liquid-solid
centrifugation, clarifiers, desludging and decanting machine, Filtration: Theory of filtration, rate of
filtration, pressure drop during filtration, applications, constant-rate filtration and constant-pressure
filtration, derivation of equation; Filtration equipment; plate and frame filter press, rotary filters,
centrifugal filters and air filters, filter aids, Membrane separation: General considerations, materials
for membrane construction, ultra-filtration, microfiltration, concentration, polarization, processing
variables, membrane fouling, applications of ultra-filtration in food processing, reverse osmosis,
mode of operation, and applications; Membrane separation methods, demineralization by electro-
dialysis, gel filtration, ion exchange, per-evaporation and osmotic dehydration.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
At the end of the course the students will be able to
CO1 understand the importance of food polymers
CO2 understand the effect of various methods of processing on the structure and texture of food
materials
CO3 understand the interaction of food constituents with respect to thermal, electrical properties to
develop new technologies for processing and preservation.
329
TEXTBOOKS:
1. R.L. Earle. 2004. Unit Operations in Food Processing. The New Zealand Intitute of Food
Science & Technology, Nz. Warren L. McCabe, Julian Smith, Peter Harriott. 2004.
2. Unit Operations of Chemical Engineering, 7th Ed. McGraw-Hill, Inc., NY, USA. Christie
John Geankoplis. 2003.
3. Transport Processes and Separation Process Principles (Includes Unit Operations), 4th
Ed. Prentice-Hall, NY, USA.
4. George D. Saravacos and Athanasios E. Kostaropoulos. 2002. Handbook of Food
Processing Equipment. Springer Science+Business Media, New York, USA.
5. J. F. Richardson, J. H. Harker and J. R. Backhurst. 2002. Coulson & Richardson's
Chemical Engineering, Vol. 2, Particle Technology and Separation Processes, 5th Ed.
UNIT I 10
Introduction to food safety and security: Hygienic design of food plants and equipments, Food
Contaminants (Microbial, Chemical, Physical), Food Adulteration (Common adulterants), Food
Additives (functional role, safety issues), Food Packaging & labeling. Sanitation in warehousing,
storage, shipping, receiving, containers and packaging materials. Control of rats, rodents, mice,
birds, insects and microbes. Cleaning and Disinfection, ISO 22000 – Importance and
Implementation
UNIT II 8
Food quality: Various Quality attributes of food, Instrumental, chemical and microbial Quality
control. Sensory evaluation of food and statistical analysis. Water quality and other utilities.
UNIT III 9
Critical Quality control point in different stages of production including raw materials and
processing materials. Food Quality and Quality control including the HACCP system. Food
inspection and Food Law, Risk assessment – microbial risk assessment, dose response and
exposure response modelling, risk management, implementation of food surveillance system to
monitor food safety, risk communication
UNIT IV 9
Indian and global regulations: FAO in India, Technical Cooperation programmes, Bio-security in
Food and Agriculture, World Health Organization (WHO), World Animal Health Organization (OIE),
International Plant Protection Convention (IPPC)
UNIT V 9
330
Codex Alimentarius Commission - Codex India – Role of Codex Contact point, National Codex
contact point (NCCP), National Codex Committee of India – ToR, Functions, Shadow Committees
etc.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
CO1 Thorough Knowledge of food hazards, physical, chemical and biological in the industry and
food service establishments
CO2 Awareness on regulatory and statutory bodies in India and the world
REFERENCES:
1. Handbook of food toxicology by S. S. Deshpande, 2002
2. The food safety information handbook by Cynthia A. Robert, 2009
3. Nutritional and safety aspects of food processing by Tannenbaum SR, Marcel Dekker Inc., New
York 1979
4. Microbiological safety of Food by Hobbs BC, 1973
5. Food Safety Handbook by Ronald H. Schmidt, Gary E. Rodrick, A John Wiley & Sons
Publication, 2003
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Bisset, Normal Grainger and Max Wich H “Herbal Drugs and
Phytopharmaceuticals”, 2nd Edition, CRC, 2001.
2. Handbook of Nutraceuticals and Functional Foods: Robert Wildman, CRC,
Publications. 2006
3. WEBB, PP, Dietary Supplements and Functional Foods Blackwell Publishing Ltd
(United Kingdom), 2006
4. Ikan, Raphael “Natural Products: A Laboratory Guide”, 2nd Edition, Academic
Press / Elsevier, 2005.
REFERENCES:
1. Asian Functional Foods (Nutraceutical Science and Technology) by John Shi
(Editor), Fereidoon Shahidi (Editor), Chi-Tang Ho (Editor), CRC Publications, Taylor
& Francis, 2007
2. Functional Foods and Nutraceuticals in Cancer Prevention by Ronald Ross Watson
(Author), Blackwell Publishing, 2007
3. Marketing Nutrition: Soy, Functional Foods, Biotechnology, and Obesity by Brian
Wansink.
4. Functional foods: Concept to Product: Edited by G R Gibson and C M Williams,
Wood head Publ., 2000
5. Hanson, James R. “Natural Products: The Secondary Metabolites”, Royal Society
of Chemistry, 2003.
REFERENCES
1. Nejat Vezirog, Alternate Energy Sources, IT, McGraw Hill, New York.
333
2. El. Wakil, Power Plant Technology, Tata McGraw Hill, New York, 2002.
3. Sukhatme. S.P., Solar Enery - Thermal Collection and Storage, Tata McGraw hill, New Delhi,
1981.
Course articulation matrix
1, 2 and 3 are correlation levels with weightings as Slight (Low), Moderate (Medium) and Substantial (High) respectively
334
Vibrational structure, Importance of UHV techniques, Electronic probes and molecular beams,
Scanning probes and diffraction, Qualitative introduction to electronic and vibrational spectroscopy
TEXT BOOK:
1. K. W. Kolasinski, “Surface Science: Foundations of catalysis and nanoscience” II Edition,
John Wiley & Sons, New York, 2008.
REFERENCE:
1. Gabor A. Somorjai and Yimin Li “Introduction to Surface Chemistry and catalysis”, II
Edition John Wiley & Sons, New York, 2010.
OBJECTIVES:
To educate about the health hazards and the safety measures to be followed in the
industrial environment.
Describe industrial legislations (Factories Acts, Workmen's Compensation and other laws)
enacted for the protection of employees health at work settings
335
Describe methods of prevention and control of Occupational Health diseases, accidents /
emergencies and other hazards
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Need for developing Environment, Health and Safety systems in work places - Accident Case
Studies - Status and relationship of Acts - Regulations and Codes of Practice - Role of trade union
safety representatives. International initiatives - Ergonomics and work place.
336
OPE354 UNIT OPERATIONS IN PETRO CHEMICAL INDUSTRIES LTPC
3003
OBJECTIVES:
To impart to the student basic knowledge on fluid mechanics, mechanical operations, heat
transfer operations and mass transfer operations.
337
TEXTBOOK(S)
1. Unit operations in Chemical Engineering Warren L. McCabe, Julian C. Smith & Peter
Harriot McGraw-Hill Education (India) Edition 2014
2. Fluid Mechanics K L Kumar S Chand & Company Ltd 2008
3. Introduction to Chemical Engineering Badger W.I. and Banchero, J.T., Tata McGraw Hill
New York 1997
REFERENCE BOOKS
1. Principles of Unit Operations Alan S Foust, L.A. Wenzel, C.W. Clump, L. Maus, and L.B.
Anderson John Wiley & Sons 2nd edition 2008
2. Unit Operations of Chemical Engineering, Vol I &II Chattopadhyaya Khanna Publishers,
Delhi-6 1996
3. Heat Transfer J P Holman McGraw Hill International Ed
338
UNIT V PLASTICS MATERIALS FOR BIOMEDICAL APPLICATIONS 9
Sources, raw materials, methods of manufacturing, properties and applications of bio-based
polymers- poly lactic acid (PLA), poly hydroxy alkanoates (PHA), PBAT, bioplastics- bio-PE, bio-
PP, bio-PET, polymers for biomedical applications
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
To study the importance, advantages and classification of plastic materials
Summarize the raw materials, sources, production, properties and applications of various
engineering thermoplastics
To understand the application of polyamides, polyesters and other engineering
thermoplastics, thermosetting resins
Know the manufacture, properties and uses of thermosetting resins based on polyester,
epoxy, silicone and PU
To understand the engineering applications of various polymers in miscellaneous areas
and applications of different biopolymers
REFERENCES
1. Marianne Gilbert (Ed.), Brydson’s Plastics Materials, 8th Edn., Elsevier (2017).
2. J.A.Brydson, Plastics Materials, 7th Edn., Butterworth Heinemann (1999).
3. Manas Chanda, Salil K. Roy, Plastics Technology Handbook, 4th Edn., CRC press (2006).
4. A. Brent Strong, Plastics: Materials and Processing, 3rd Edn., Pearson Prentice Hall (2006).
5. Olagoke Olabisi, Kolapo Adewale (Eds.), Handbook of Thermoplastics 2nd
Edn., CRC press (2016).
6. Charles A. Harper, Modern Plastics Handbook, McGraw-Hill, New York, 1999.
7. H. Dominighaus, Plastics for Engineers, Hanser Publishers, Munich, 1988.
REFERENCES
1. F.Majewska, H.Zowall, Handbook of analysis of synthetic polymers and plastics, Ellis
Horwood Limited Publisher 1977.
2. J.F.Rabek, Experimental Methods in Polymer Chemistry, John Wiley and Sons 1980.
3. R.P.Brown, Plastic test methods, 2nd Edn., Harlond, Longman Scientific, 1981.
4. A. B. Mathur, I. S. Bharadwaj, Testing and Evaluation of Plastcis, Allied Publishers Pvt.
Ltd., New Delhi, 2003.
5. Vishu Shah, Handbook of Plastic Testing Technology, 3rd Edn., John Wiley & Sons 2007.
6. S. K. Nayak, S. N. Yadav, S. Mohanty, Fundamentals of Plastic Testing, Springer, 2010.
340
MOS logic families (NMOS and CMOS), Ideal and Non Ideal IV Characteristics, CMOS devices.
MOS(FET) Transistor DC transfer Characteristics ,small signal analysis of MOSFET.
TEXTBOOKS
1. Jan D Rabaey, Anantha Chandrakasan, “Digital Integrated Circuits: A Design Perspective”,
PHI, 2016.(Units II, III IV and V).
2. Neil H E Weste, Kamran Eshranghian, “Principles of CMOS VLSI Design: A System
Perspective,” Addison Wesley, 2009.( Units - I).
REFERENCES
1. D.A. Hodges and H.G. Jackson, Analysis and Design of Digital Integrated Circuits,
International Student Edition, McGraw Hill 1983
2. P. Rashinkar, Paterson and L. Singh, "System-on-a-Chip Verification-Methodology and
Techniques", Kluwer Academic Publishers,2001
3. Samiha Mourad and Yervant Zorian, “Principles of Testing Electronic Systems”, Wiley 2000
4. M. Bushnell and V. D. Agarwal, "Essentials of Electronic Testing for Digital, Memory and
Mixed-Signal VLSI Circuits", Kluwer Academic Publishers,2000
341
CBM370 WEARABLE DEVICES LTPC
3 003
OBJECTIVES:
The student should be made to:
To know the hardware requirement of wearable systems
To understand the communication and security aspects in the wearable devices
To know the applications of wearable devices in the field of medicine
REFERENCES
342
1. Sandeep K.S, Gupta, Tridib Mukherjee and Krishna Kumar Venkatasubramanian, Body
Area Networks Safety, Security, and Sustainability, Cambridge University Press, 2013.
2. Guang-Zhong Yang, Body Sensor Networks, Springer, 2006.
TEXT BOOKS:
1. Mohan Bansal, “Medical informatics”, Tata McGraw Hill Publishing Ltd, 2003.
2. R.D.Lele, “Computers in medicine progress in medical informatics”, Tata Mcgraw Hill,2005
REFERENCES:
1. Kathryn J. Hannah, Marion J Ball, “Health Informatics”, 3rd Edition, Springer, 2006.
344
Overview of composting process - Benefitis of composting, Role of microorganisms in composting
- Factors affecting the composting process - Waste Materials for Composting, Fundamentals of
composting process - Composting technologies, Composting systems – Nonreactor Composting,
Reactor composting - Compost Quality
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES
After completion of this course, the students should be able
1. To learn the various methods biological treatment
2. To know the details of waste biomass and its value addition
3. To develop the bioconversion processes to convert wastes to energy
4. To synthesize the chemicals and enzyme from wastes
5. To produce the biocompost from wastes
6. To apply the theoretical knowledge for the development of value added products
TEXT BOOKS
1. Antoine P. T., (2017) “Biofuels from Food Waste Applications of Saccharification Using Fungal
Solid State Fermentation”, CRC press
2. Joseph C A., (2019)“Anaerobic Waste-Wastewater Treatment and Biogas Plants-A Practical
Handbook”, CRC Press,
REFERENCE BOOKS
1. Palmiro P. and Oscar F.D’Urso, (2016) ‘Biotransformation of Agricultural
Waste and By-Products’,The Food, Feed, Fibre, Fuel (4F) Economy, Elsevier
2. Kaur Brar S., Gurpreet Singh D. and Carlos R.S., (Eds), (2014)‘Biotransformation of Waste
Biomass into High Value Biochemicals’, Springer.
3. Keikhosro K, Editor, (2015) ‘Lignocellulose-Based Bioproducts’, Springer.
4. John P, (2014) ‘Waste Management Practices-Municipal, Hazardous, and Industrial’, Second
Edition, CRC Press, 2014
UNIT II CANCER 9
Types - Lung cancer, Mouth cancer, Skin cancer, Cervical cancer, Carcinoma oesophagus;
Causes Tobacco usage, Diagnosis – Biomarkers, Treatment
345
1. R.Kumar&Meenal Kumar, “Guide to Prevention of Lifestyle Diseases”, Deep & Deep
Publications, 2003
2. Gary Eggar et al, “Lifestyle Medicine”, 3rd Edition, Academic Press, 2017
REFERENCES:
1. James M.R, “Lifestyle Medicine”, 2nd Edition, CRC Press, 2013
2. Akira Miyazaki et al, “New Frontiers in Lifestyle-Related Disease”, Springer, 2008
REFERENCE BOOKS
346
1. Suh, Sang, Gurupur, Varadraj P., Tanik, Murat M., Health Care Systems, Technology
and Techniques, Springer, 1st Edition, 2011
2. Burtis & Ashwood W.B. Tietz Textbook of Clinical chemistry. Saunders Company
3. Levine, M. M. (2004). New Generation Vaccines. New York: M. Dekker
REFERENCES .
1. James C. Vanhorne –Fundamentals of Financial Management– PHI Learning,.
2. Prasanna Chandra, Financial Management,
3. Srivatsava, Mishra, Financial Management, Oxford University Press, 2011
347
CMG332 FUNDAMENTALS OF INVESTMENT LT P C
3003
OBJECTIVES:
1. Describe the investment environment in which investment decisions are taken.
2. Explain how to Value bonds and equities
3. Explain the various approaches to value securities
4. Describe how to create efficient portfolios through diversification
5. Discuss the mechanism of investor protection in India.
348
UNIT I INTRODUCTION TO INDIAN BANKING SYSTEM 9
Overview of Banking system – Structure – Functions –Banking system in India - Key Regulations
in Indian Banking sector –RBI. Relationship between Banker and Customer - Retail & Wholesale
Banking – types of Accounts - Opening and operation of Accounts.
UNIT V INSURANCE 9
Insurance –Concept - Need - History of Insurance industry in India. Insurance Act, 1938 –IRDA –
Regulations – Life Insurance - Annuities and Unit Linked Policies - Lapse of the Policy – revival –
settlement of claim
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
REFERENCES :
1. Padmalatha Suresh and Justin Paul, “Management of Banking and Financial Services, Pearson,
Delhi, 2017.
2. Meera Sharma, “Management of Financial Institutions – with emphasis on Bank and Risk
Management”, PHI Learning Pvt. Ltd., New Delhi 2010
3. Peter S. Rose and Sylvia C. and Hudgins, “Bank Management and Financial Services”, Tata
McGraw Hill, New Delhi, 2017
349
Introduction - The Ethereum network - Components of the Ethereum ecosystem - Transactions
and messages - Ether cryptocurrency / tokens (ETC and ETH) - The Ethereum Virtual Machine
(EVM), Ethereum Development Environment: Test networks - Setting up a private net - Starting up
the private network
350
1. Swanson Seth, Fintech for Beginners: Understanding and Utilizing the power of
technology, Createspace Independent Publishing Platform,2016.
2. Models AuTanda, Fintech Bigtech And Banks Digitalization and Its Impact On Banking
Business, Springer, 2019
3. Henning Diedrich, Ethereum: Blockchains, Digital Assets, Smart Contracts, Decentralized
Autonomous Organizations, Wildfire Publishing, 2016
4. Jacob William, FinTech:TheBeginner’s Guide to Financial Technology, Createspace
Independent Publishing Platform, 2016
5. IIBF, Digital Banking, Taxmann Publication, 2016
6. Jacob William, Financial Technology, Create space Independent Pub, 2016
7. Luke Sutton, Financial Technology: Bitcoin & Blockchain, Createspace Independent Pub,
2016
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Fintech - Definition, History, concept, meaning, architecture, significance, Goals, key areas in
Fintech, Importance of Fintech, role of Fintech in economic development, opportunities and
challenges in Fintech, Evolution of Fintech in different sectors of the industry - Infrastructure,
Banking Industry, Startups and Emerging Markets, recent developments in FinTech, future
prospects and potential issues with Fintech.
VERTICAL 2: ENTREPRENEURSHIP
352
TOTAL45 : PERIODS
OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of this course, the student should be able to:
CO 1 Learn the basics of Entrepreneurship
CO 2 Understand the business ownership patterns and evnironment
CO 3 Understand the Job opportunites in Industries relating to Technopreneurship
CO 4 Learn about applications of tehnopreneurship and successful technopreneurs
CO 5 Acquaint with the recent and emerging trends in entrepreneruship
TEXT BOOKS:
1) S.S.Khanka, “Entrepreneurial Development” S.Chand & Co. Ltd. Ram Nagar New Delhi,
2021.
2) Donal F Kuratko Entrepreneurship (11th Edition) Theory, Process, Practice by Published
2019 by Cengage Learning,
REFERENCES :
1) Daniel Mankani. 2003. Technopreneurship: The successful Entrepreneur in the new
Economy. Prentice Hall
2) Edward Elgar. 2007. Entrepreneurship, Cooperation and the Firm: The Emergence and
Survival of High-Technology Ventures in Europe. Edi: Jan Ulijn, Dominique Drillon, and
Frank Lasch. Wiley Pub.
3) Lang, J. 2002, The High Tech Entrepreneur's Handbook, Ft.com.
4) David Sheff 2002, China Dawn: The Story of a Technology and Business Revolution,
5) HarperBusiness,https://fanny.staff.uns.ac.id/files/2013/12/Technopreneur-BASED-
EDUCATION-REVOLUTION.pdf
6) JumpStart: A Technoprenuership Fable, Dennis Posadas, (Singapore: Pearson Prentice
Hall, 2009
7) Basics of Technoprenuership: Module 1.1-1.2, Frederico Gonzales, President-PESO Inc;
M. Barcelon, UP
8) Journal articles pertaining to Entrepreneurship
REFERENCES :
1. Hughes, R.L., Ginnett, R.C., & Curphy, G.J., Leadership: Enhancing the lessons of
experience ,9th Ed, McGraw Hill Education, Chennai, India. (2019).
2. Katzenback, J.R., Smith, D.K., The Wisdom of Teams: Creating the High Performance
Organisations, Harvard Business Review Press, (2015).
3. Haldar, U.K., Leadership and Team Building, Oxford University Press, (2010).
4. Daft, R.L., The Leadership Experience, Cengage, (2015).
5. Daniel Levi, Group Dynamics for Teams ,4th Ed, (2014), Sage Publications.
6. Dyer, W. G., Dyer, W. G., Jr., & Dyer, J. H..Team building: Proven strategies for improving
team performance, 5thed, Jossey-Bass, (2013).
UNIT I CREATIVITY 9
Creativity: Definition- Forms of Creativity-Essence, Elaborative and Expressive Creativities-
Quality of Creativity-Existential, Entrepreneurial and Empowerment Creativities – Creative
Environment- Creative Technology- - Creative Personality and Motivation.
Suggested Readings:
Creativity and Inovation in Entrepreneurship, Kankha, Sultan Chand
Pradip N Khandwalla, Lifelong Creativity, An Unending Quest, Tata Mc Graw Hill, 2004.
Paul Trott, Innovation Management and New Product Development, 4e, Pearson, 2018.
Vinnie Jauhari, Sudanshu Bhushan, Innovation Management, Oxford Higher Education, 2014.
Innovation Management, C.S.G. Krishnamacharyulu, R. Lalitha, Himalaya Publishing House,
2010.
A. Dale Timpe, Creativity, Jaico Publishing House, 2003.
Brian Clegg, Paul Birch, Creativity, Kogan Page, 2009.
Strategic Innovation: Building and Sustaining Innovative Organizations- Course Era, Raj
Echambadi.
355
To give them an understanding of fundamental premise underlying market driven strategies
and the basic philosophies and tools of marketing management for business owners.
356
CMG341 HUMAN RESOURCE MANAGEMENT FOR ENTREPRENEURS L T P C
3003
OBJECTIVES:
1. To introduce the basic concepts, structure and functions of human resource management for
entrepreneurs.
2. To create an awareness of the roles, functions and functioning of human resource department.
3.To understand the methods and techniques followed by Human Resource Management
practitioners.
REFERENCES
1) Gary Dessler and Biju Varkkey, Human Resource Management, 14e , Pearson, 2015.
2) Mathis and Jackson, Human Resource Management, Cengage Learning 15e, 2017.
3) David A. Decenzo, Stephen.P.Robbins, and Susan L. Verhulst, Human Resource
Management, Wiley, International Student Edition, 11th Edition, 2014
4) R. Wayne Mondy, Human Resource Management, Pearson , 2015.
5) Luis R.Gomez-Mejia, David B.Balkin, Robert L Cardy. Managing Human Resource. PHI
Learning. 2012
6) John M. Ivancevich, Human Resource Management,12e, McGraw Hill Irwin,2013.
357
7) K. Aswathappa, Sadhna Dash , Human Resource Management - Text and Cases , 9th
Edition, McGraw Hill, 2021.
8) Uday Kumar Haldar, Juthika Sarkar. Human Resource management. Oxford. 2012
REFERENCES :
1) Principles of Corporate Finance by Brealey and Myers et al.,12TH ed, McGraw Hill
Education (India) Private Limited, 2018
2) Prasanna Chandra, Projects : Planning ,Analysis,Selection ,Financing,Implementation and
Review, McGraw Hilld Education India Pvt Ltd ,New Delhi , 2019.
3) Introduction to Project Finance. Andrew Fight,Butterworth-Heinemann, 2006.
4) Metrick, Andrew; Yasuda, Ayako. Venture Capital And The Finance Of Innovation. Venture
Capital And The Finance Of Innovation, 2nd Edition, Andrew Metrick And Ayako Yasuda,
Eds., John Wiley And Sons, Inc, 2010.
358
5) Feld, Brad; Mendelson, Jason. Venture Deals. Wiley, 2011.
6) May, John; Simons, Cal. Every Business Needs An Angel: Getting The Money You Need
To Make Your Business Grow. Crown Business, 2001.
7) Gompers, Paul Alan; Lerner, Joshua. The Money Of Invention: How Venture Capital
Creates New Wealth. Harvard Business Press, 2001.
8) Camp, Justin J. Venture Capital Due Diligence: A Guide To Making Smart Investment
Choices And Increasing Your Portfolio Returns. John Wiley & Sons, 2002.
9) Byers, Thomas. Technology Ventures: From Idea To Enterprise. Mcgraw-Hill Higher
Education, 2014.
10) Lerner, Josh; Leamon, Ann; Hardymon, Felda. Venture Capital, Private Equity, And The
Financing Of Entrepreneurship. 2012.
UNIT-II (9)
1. New Public Administration
2. New Public Management
3. Public and Private Administration
UNIT-III (9)
1. Relationships with Political Science, History and Sociology
2. Classical Approach
3. Scientific Management Approach
UNIT-IV (9)
1. Bureaucratic Approach: Max Weber
2. Human Relations Approach : Elton Mayo
3. Ecological Approach : Riggs
UNIT-V (9)
1. Leadership: Leadership - Styles - Approaches
2. Communication: Communication Types - Process - Barriers
3. Decision Making: Decision Making - Types, Techniques and Processes.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
REFERENCEs:
1. Avasthi and Maheswari: Public Administration in India, Agra:Lakshmi Narain Agarwal,2013.
2. Ramesh K Arora: Indian Public Administration, New Delhi: Wishwa Prakashan, 2012.
3. R.B. Jain: Public Administration in India,21st Century Challenges for Good Governance, New
Delhi: Deep and Deep, 2002.
4. Rumki Basu: Public Administration:Concept and Theories, New Delhi:Sterling, 2013.
5. R. Tyagi, Public Administration, Atma Ram & Sons, New Delhi, 1983.
359
CMG344 CONSTITUTION OF INDIA LTPC
3003
UNIT-I (9)
1. Constitutional Development Since 1909 to 1947
2. Making of the Constitution.
3. Constituent Assembly
UNIT-II (9)
1. Fundamental Rights
2. Fundamental Duties
3. Directive Principles of State Policy
UNIT-III (9)
1. President
2. Parliament
3. Supreme Court
UNIT-IV (9)
1. Governor
2. State Legislature
3. High Court
UNIT-V (9)
1. Secularism
2. Social Justice
3. Minority Safeguards
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
REFERENCES:
1. Basu. D.D.: Introduction to Indian Constitution ; Prentice Hall; New Delhi.
2. Kapur. A.C: Indian Government and Political System; S.Chand and Company Ltd., New Delhi.
3. Johari J.C.: Indian Politics, Vishal Publications Ltd, New Delhi
4. Agarwal R.C: Indian Political System; S.Chand & Co., New Delhi
UNIT-II (9)
1. Generalist Vs Specialist
2. Civil Servants’ Relationship with Political Executive
3. Integrity in Administration.
UNIT-III (9)
1. Recruitment: Direct Recruitment and Recruitment from Within
2. Training: Kinds of Training
3. Promotion
UNIT-IV (9)
1. All India Services
2. Service Conditions
360
3. State Public Service Commission
UNIT-V (9)
1. Employer Employee Relations
2. Wage and Salary Administration
3. Allowances and Benefits
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
REFERENCES:
1. Stahl Glean O: Public Personnel Administration
2. Parnandikar Pai V.A: Personnel System for Development Administration.
3. Bhambhiru . P: Bureaucracy and Policy in India.
4. Dwivedi O.P and Jain R.B: India’s Administrative state.
5. Muttalis M.A: Union Public Service Commission.
6. Bhakara Rao .V: Employer Employee Relations in India.
7. Davar R.S. Personnel Management & Industrial Relations
UNIT II (9)
Theories of Organization: Scientific Management Theory, Classical Model,
Human Relations Theory
UNIT IV (9)
Motivation Theories, content, process and contemporary; Theories of Leadership: Traditional and
Modern: Process and techniques of decision-making
UNIT V (9)
Administrative thinkers: Kautilya, Woodrow Willson, C.I. Barnard . Peter Drucker
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
REFERENCES:
1. Crozior M : The Bureaucratic phenomenon (Chand)
2. Blau. P.M and Scott. W : Formal Organizations (RKP)
3. Presthus. R : The Organizational Society (MAC)
4. Alvi, Shum Sun Nisa : Eminent Administrative Thinkers.
5. Keith Davis : Organization Theory (MAC)
361
CMG347 INDIAN ADMINISTRATIVE SYSTEM LTPC
3 00 3
UNIT I (9)
Evolution and Constitutional Context of Indian Administration, Constitutional Authorities: Finance
Commission, Union Public Services Commission, Election Commission, Comptroller and Auditor
General of India, Attorney General of India
UNIT II (9)
Role & Functions of the District Collector, Relationship between the District
Collector and Superintendent of Police, Role of Block Development Officer in development
programmes, Local Government
UNIT IV (9)
Coalition politics in India, Integrity and Vigilance in Indian Administration
UNIT V (9)
Corruption – Ombudsman, Lok Pal & Lok Ayuktha
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
REFERENCES:
1. S.R. Maheswari : Indian Administration
2. Khera. S.S : Administration in India
3. Ramesh K. Arora : Indian Public Administration
4. T.N. Chaturvedi : State administration in India
5. Basu, D.D : Introduction to the Constitution of India
UNIT-II (9)
Approaches in Policy Analysis - Institutional Approach – Incremental Approach and System’s
Approach – Dror’s Optimal Model
UNIT-III (9)
Major stages involved in Policy making Process – Policy Formulation – Policy Implementation –
Policy Evaluation.
UNIT-IV (9)
Institutional Framework of Policy making – Role of Bureaucracy – Role of Interest Groups and
Role of Political Parties.
UNIT-V (9)
Introduction to the following Public Policies – New Economic Policy – Population Policy –
Agriculture policy - Information Technology Policy.
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
362
REFERENCES:
1. Rajesh Chakrabarti & Kaushik Sanyal : Public Policy in India, Oxford University Press, 2016.
2. Kuldeep Mathur : Public Policy and Politics in India, Oxford University Press, 2016.
3. Bidyutv Chakrabarty: Public Policy: Concept, Theory and Practice, 2015.
4. Pradeep Saxena : Public Policy Administration and Development
5. Sapru R.K. : Public Policy: Formulation, Implementation and Evaluation, Sterling Publishers,
2016.
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Basic definitions and rules for probability, Baye‘s theorem and random variables, Probability
distributions: Binomial, Poisson, Uniform and Normal distributions.
REFERENCES:
1. Richard I. Levin, David S. Rubin, Masood H.Siddiqui, Sanjay Rastogi, Statistics for
Management, Pearson Education, 8th Edition, 2017.
2. Prem. S. Mann, Introductory Statistics, Wiley Publications, 9th Edition, 2015.
3. T N Srivastava and Shailaja Rego, Statistics for Management, Tata McGraw Hill, 3rd Edition
2017.
4. Ken Black, Applied Business Statistics, 7th Edition, Wiley India Edition, 2012.
363
5. David R. Anderson, Dennis J. Sweeney, Thomas A.Williams, Jeffrey D.Camm, James
J.Cochran, Statistics for business and economics, 13th edition, Thomson (South – Western) Asia,
Singapore, 2016.
6. N. D. Vohra, Business Statistics, Tata McGraw Hill, 2017.
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Data mining, Text mining, Web mining, Data ware house.
REFERENCES :
1. Jaiwei Ham and Micheline Kamber, Data Mining concepts and techniques, Kauffmann
Publishers 2006
2. Efraim Turban, Ramesh Sharda, Jay E. Aronson and David King, Business Intelligence,
Prentice Hall, 2008.
3. W.H.Inmon, Building the Data Warehouse, fourth edition Wiley India pvt. Ltd. 2005.
4. Ralph Kimball and Richard Merz, The data warehouse toolkit, John Wiley, 3rd edition,2013.
5. Michel Berry and Gordon Linoff, Mastering Data mining, John Wiley and Sons Inc, 2nd Edition,
2011
6. Michel Berry and Gordon Linoff, Data mining techniques for Marketing, Sales and Customer
support, John Wiley, 2011
7. G. K. Gupta, Ïntroduction to Data mining with Case Studies, Prentice hall of India, 2011
8. Giudici, Applied Data mining – Statistical Methods for Business and Industry, John Wiley. 2009
9. Elizabeth Vitt, Michael Luckevich Stacia Misner, Business Intelligence, Microsoft, 2011
10. Michalewicz Z., Schmidt M. Michalewicz M and Chiriac C, Adaptive Business Intelligence,
Springer – Verlag, 2007
11. GalitShmueli, Nitin R. Patel and Peter C. Bruce, Data Mining for Business Intelligence –
Concepts, Techniques and Applications Wiley, India, 2010.
364
CMG351 HUMAN RESOURCE ANALYTICS LTPC
3003
OBJECTIVE:
To develop the ability of the learners to define and implement HR metrics that are aligned
with the overall business strategy.
To know the different types of HR metrics and understand their respective impact and
application.
To understand the impact and use of HR metrics and their connection with HR analytics.
To understand common workforce issues and resolving them using people analytics.
REFERENCES:
1. JacFitzenz , The New HR Analytics, AMACOM , 2010.
2. Edwards M. R., & Edwards K, Predictive HR Analytics: Mastering the HR Metric.London: Kogan
Page.2016.
3. Human Resources kit for Dummies – 3 rd edition – Max Messmer, 2003
4. Dipak Kumar Bhattacharyya, HR Analytics ,Understanding Theories and
Applications, SAGE Publications India ,2017.
5. Sesil, J. C. , Applying advanced analytics to HR management decisions: Methods fo selection,
developing incentives, and improving collaboration. Upper Saddle River,New Jersey: Pearson
Education,2014.
6. Pease, G., & Beresford, B, Developing Human Capital: Using Analytics to Plan and Optimize
Your Learning and Development Investments. Wiley ,2014.
7. Phillips, J., & Phillips, P.P, Making Human Capital Analytics Work: Measuring the ROI of Human
Capital Processes and OUTCOME. McGraw-Hill,2014.
8. HR Scorecard and Metrices, HBR, 2001.
365
CMG352 MARKETING AND SOCIAL MEDIA WEB ANALYTICS LTPC
3003
OBJECTIVE:
To showcase the opportunities that exist today to leverage the power of the web and social
media
REFERENCES:
1. K. M. Shrivastava, Social Media in Business and Governance, Sterling Publishers Private
Limited, 2013
2. Christian Fuchs, Social Media a critical introduction, SAGE Publications Ltd, 2014
3. Bittu Kumar, Social Networking, V & S Publishers, 2013
4. Avinash Kaushik, Web Analytics - An Hour a Day, Wiley Publishing, 2007
5. Ric T. Peterson, Web Analytics Demystified, Celilo Group Media and CafePress 2004
6. Takeshi Moriguchi, Web Analytics Consultant Official Textbook, 7th Edition, 2016
UNIT I INTRODUCTION 9
Descriptive, predictive and prescriptive analytics, Data Driven Supply Chains – Basics,
transforming supply chains.
366
UNIT II WAREHOUSING DECISIONS 9
P-Median Methods - Guided LP Approach, Greedy Drop Heuristics, Dynamic Location Models,
Space Determination and Layout Methods.
REFERENCES:
1. Nada R. Sanders, Big data driven supply chain management: A framework for implementing
analytics and turning information into intelligence, Pearson Education, 2014.
2. Michael Watson, Sara Lewis, Peter Cacioppi, Jay Jayaraman, Supply Chain Network Design:
Applying Optimization and Analytics to the Global Supply Chain, Pearson Education, 2013.
3. Anna Nagurney, Min Yu, Amir H. Masoumi, Ladimer S. Nagurney, Networks Against Time:
Supply Chain Analytics for Perishable Products, Springer, 2013.
4. Muthu Mathirajan, Chandrasekharan Rajendran, Sowmyanarayanan Sadagopan, Arunachalam
Ravindran, Parasuram Balasubramanian, Analytics in
Operations/Supply Chain Management , I.K. International Publishing House Pvt. Ltd., 2016.
5. Gerhard J. Plenert, Supply Chain Optimization through Segmentation and Analytics, CRC Press,
Taylor & Francis Group, 2014.
367
UNIT IV TECHNICAL ANALYSIS 9
Prediction using charts and fundamentals – RSI, ROC, MACD, moving average and candle charts,
simulating trading strategies. Prediction of share prices.
REFERENCES:
1. Financial analytics with R by Mark J. Bennett, Dirk L. Hugen, Cambridge university press.
2. Haskell Financial Data Modeling and Predictive Analytics Paperback – Import, 25 Oct 2013 by
Pavel Ryzhov.
3. Quantitative Financial Analytics: The Path To Investment Profits Paperback – Import, 11 Sep
2017 by Edward E Williams (Author), John A Dobelman.
4. Python for Finance - Paperback – Import, 30 Jun 2017 by Yuxing Yan (Author).
5. Mastering Python for Finance Paperback – Import, 29 Apr 2015 by James Ma Weiming.
REFERENCES:
1. Charles J Kibert, Sustainable Construction : Green Building Design & Delivery, 4th Edition ,
Wiley Publishers 2016.
2. Steve Goodhew, Sustainable Construction Process, Wiley Blackwell,UK, 2016.
3. Craig A. Langston & Grace K.C. Ding, Sustainable Practices in the Built Environment,
Butterworth Heinemann Publishers, 2011.
4. William P Spence, Construction Materials, Methods & Techniques (3e), Yesdee Publication
Pvt. Ltd, 2016.
5. New Building Materials and Construction World magazine
6. Kerry Turner. R, "Sustainable Environmental Management", Principles and Practice
Publisher:Belhaven Press,ISBN:1852930039.
7. Munier N, "Introduction to Sustainability”, Springer2005
8. Sharma, “Sustainable Smart Cities In India: Challenges And Future Perspectives”,
SPRINGER, 2022.
9. Ralph Horne, Tim Grant, KarliVerghese, Life Cycle Assessment: Principles, Practice and
Prospects, Csiro Publishing,2009
369
10. European Commission - Joint Research Centre - Institute for Environment and Sustainability:
International Reference Life Cycle Data System (ILCD) Handbook - General guide for Life
Cycle Assessment - Detailed guidance. Luxembourg. European Union;2010
11. Hudson, Haas, Uddin, Infrastructure management: integrating design, construction,
maintenance, rehabilitation, and renovation, McGraw Hill, (1997).
12. GregerLundesjö, Supply Chain Management and Logistics in Construction: Delivering
Tomorrow's Built Environment, Kogan Page Publishers, 2015.
REFERENCES:
1. Approaches to Sustainable Agriculture – Exploring the Pathways Towards the Future of
Farming, Oberc, B.P. & Arroyo Schnell, A., IUCN, Belgium, 2020
2. Natural bioactive products in sustainable agriculture, Singh, J. & Yadav, A.N., Springer,
2020
3. Organic Farming for Sustainable Agriculture, Nandwani, D., Springer, 2016
4. Principles of Agronomy for Sustainable Agriculture, Villalobos, F.J. & Fereres, E., Springer,
2016
5. Sustainable Agriculture for Food Security: A Global Perspective, Balkrishna, A., CRC
Press, 2021
6. Sustainable Energy Solutions in Agriculture, Bundschuh, J. & Chen, G., CRC Press, 2014
371
To make the students understand the significance of bionanomaterials and its
applications.
UNIT V NANOBIOMATERIALS 9
Meatllicnanobiomaterials–Nanopolymers-Nanoceramics- Nanocomposites -Carbon based
nanobiomaterials - transport of nanoparticles- release rate-positive and negative effect of
nanosize-nanofibres-Nano and micro features and their importance in implant performance-
Nanosurface and coats-Applications nanoantibiotics-Nanomedicines- Biochips – Biomimetics-
BioNEMs -Biosensor-Bioimaging/Molecular Imaging- challenges and future perspective.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
OUTCOMES
Students will gain familiarity with Biomaterials and they will understand their importance.
Students will get an overview of different biopolymers and their properties
Students gain knowledge on some of the important Bioceramics and Biocomposite
materials
Students gain knowledge on metals as biomaterials
Student gains knowledge on the importance of nanobiomaterials in biomedical
applications.
REFERENCES
1. C. Mauli Agrawal, Joo L. Ong, Mark R. Appleford, Gopinath Mani “Introduction to
Biomaterials Basic Theory with Engineering Applications” Cambridge University Press,
2014.
2. Donglu shi “Introduction to Biomaterials” Tsinghua University press, 2006.
3. Joon Park, R.S.Lakes “Biomaterials An Introduction” third edition, Springer 2007.
372
4. M.Jaffe,W.Hammond, P.Tolias and T.Arinzeh “Characterization of Biomaterials” Wood
head publishing, 2013.
5. Buddy D.Ratner and Allan S.Hoffman Biomaterials Science “An Introduction to Material in
Medicine” Third Edition, 2013.
6. VasifHasirci, NesrinHasirci “Fundamentals of Biomaterials” Springer, 2018
7. Leopoido Javier Rios Gonzalez. “Handbook of Research on Bioenergy and Biomaterials:
Consolidated and green process” Apple academic press, 2021.
8. Devarajan Thangadurai, Jeyabalan Sangeetha, Ram Prasad “Functional Bionanomaterials”
springer, 2020.
9. Sujata.V.Bhat Biomaterials; Narosa Publishing house, 2002.
UNIT IV PHOTOVOLTAICS 9
Physics of the solar cell – Theoretical limits of photovoltaic conversion – bulk crystal growth of Si
and wafering for photovoltaic application - Crystalline silicon solar cells – thin film silicon solar
cells – multijunction solar cells – amorphous silicon based solar cells – photovoltaic concentrators
– Cu(InGa)Se2 solar cells – Cadium Telluride solar cells – dye sensitized solar cells – Perovskite
373
solar cells – Measurement and characterization of solar cells - Materials used in solar cells (
metallic oxides, CNT films, graphene, OD fullerenes, single-multi walled carbon nanotubes, two-
dimensional Graphene, organic or Small molecule-based solar cells materials - copper-
phthalocyanine and perylenetetracarboxylicbis - benzine – fullerenes - boron subphthalocyanine-
tin (II) phthalocyanine)
UNIT V SUPERCAPACITORS 9
Supercapacitor –types of supercapacitors (electrostatic double-layer capacitors, pseudo capacitors
and hybrid capacitors) - design of supercapacitor-three and two electrode cell-parameters of
supercapacitor- Faradaic and non - Faradaic capacitance – electrode materials (transition metal
oxides (MO), mixed metal oxides, conducting polymers (CP), Mxenes, nanocarbons, non-noble
metal, chalcogenides, hydroxides and 1D-3D metal-organic frame work (MOF), activated carbon
fibres (ACF)- Hydroxides-Based Materials - Polyaniline (PANI), a ternary hybrid composite-
conductive polypyrrole hydrogels – Different types of nanocomposites for the SC electrodes
(carbon–carbon composites, carbon-MOs composites, carbon-CPs composites and MOs-CPs
composites) - Two-Dimensional (2D) Electrode Materials - 2D transition metal carbides,
carbonitrides, and nitrides.
TOTAL : 45 PERIODS
OUTCOMES
Students will acquire knowledge about energy sustainability.
Students understand the principles of different electrochemical devices.
Students learn about the working of fuel cells and their application.
Students will learn about various Photovoltaic applications and the materials used.
The students gain knowledge on different types of supercapacitors and the performance of
various materials
REFERENCES
1. Functional materials for sustainable energy applications; John A. Kilner, Stephen J.
Skinner, Stuart J. C. Irvine and Peter P. Edwards.
2. Hand Book of Fuel Cells: Fuel Cell Technology and Applications, Wolf Vielstich, Arnold
Lamm, Hubert Andreas Gasteiger, Harumi Yokokawa, Wiley, London 2003.
3. B.E. Conway, Electrochemical supercapacitors: scientific fundamentals and technological
applications, Kluwer Academic / Plenum publishers, New York, 1999.
4. T.R. Crompton, Batteries reference book, Newners, 3rd Edition, 2002.
5. Materials for Supercapacitor applications; B.Viswanathan. M.Aulice Scibioh
6. Electrode Materials for Supercapacitors: A Review of Recent Advances, Parnia
Forouzandeh, Vignesh Kumaravel and Suresh C. Pillai, catalysts 2020.
7. Recent advances, practical challenges, and perspectives of intermediate temperature solid
oxide fuel cell cathodes Amanda Ndubuisi, Sara Abouali, Kalpana Singh and
VenkataramanThangadurai, J. Mater. Chem. A, 2022.
8. Review of next generation photovoltaic solar cell technology and comparative materialistic
development Neeraj Kant, Pushpendra Singh, Materials Today: Proceedings, 2022.
374
UNIT I PRINCIPLES OF GREEN CHEMISTRY 9
Historical Perspectives and Basic Concepts. The twelve Principles of Green Chemistry and green
engineering. Green chemistry metrics- atom economy, E factor, reaction mass efficiency, and
other green chemistry metrics, application of green metrics analysis to synthetic plans.
TEXT BOOKS
1. Green technology and design for the environment, Samir B. Billatos, Nadia A. Basaly, Taylor &
Francis, Washington, DC, ©1997
2. Green Chemistry – An introductory text - M. Lancaster, RSC,2016.
3. Green chemistry metrics - Alexi Lapkin and david Constable (Eds) , Wiley publications,2008
REFERENCE BOOKS
1. Environmental chemistry, Stanley E Manahan, Taylor and Francis, 2017
375
quality standard- Environmental Monitoring-Need for environmental monitoring- Concepts of
environmental monitoring- Techniques of Environmental Monitoring.
TEXTBOOKS
1. Environmental monitoring Handbook, Frank R. Burden, © 2002 by The McGraw-Hill
Companies, Inc.
2. Handbook of environmental analysis: chemical pollutants in the air, water, soil, and soild
wastes / Pradyot Patnaik, © 1997 by CRC Press, Inc
REFERENCES
1. Environmental monitoring / edited by G. Bruce Wiersma, © 2004 by CRC Press LLC.
2. H. H. Willard, L. L. Merit, J. A. Dean and F. A. Settle, Instrumental Methods of Analysis,
CBP Publishers and Distributors, New Delhi, 1988.
3. Heaslip, G. (1975) Environmental Data Handling. John Wiley & Sons. New York.
376
Course Articulation Matrix
REFERENCES:
1. Energy Manager Training Manual (4Volumes) available at http://www.em-
ea.org/gbook1.asp, a website administered by Bureau of Energy Efficiency (BEE), a
statutory body under Ministry of Power, Government of India.2004
2. Robert Ristirer and Jack P. Kraushaar, “Energy and the environment”, Willey, 2005.
3. Godfrey Boyle, “Renewable Energy, Power for a Sustainable Future”, Oxford University
Press, U.K., 2012
4. Twidell, J.W. & Weir A., “Renewable Energy Resources”, EFNSpon Ltd., UK, 2015.
5. Dhandapani Alagiri, Energy Security in India Current Scenario, The ICFAI University Press,
2006.
6. M.H. Fulekar,Bhawana Pathak, R K Kale,“Environment and Sustainable Development”
Springer,2016
7. https://www.niti.gov.in/verticals/energy
378
UNIT V SUSTAINABLE DEVELOPMENT 9
Sustainable Development: Concepts and Stakeholders, Sustainable Development Goal (SDG).
Globalization and Economic growth. Economic development: Economic inequalities, Income and
growth. Social development: Poverty, conceptual issues and measures, impact of poverty,
TOTAL: 45 PERIODS
COURSE OUTCOMES:
Upon completion of this course, the students will be able to
1. Understand the prevailing energy scenario
2. Familiarise on energy audits and its relevance
3. Apply the concept of energy audit on thermal utilities
4. Employ relevant techniques for energy improvement in electrical utilities
5. Understand Sustainable development and its impact on human resource development
REFERENCES:
1. Energy Manager Training Manual (4Volumes) available at http://www.em-
ea.org/gbook1.asp, a website administered by Bureau of Energy Efficiency (BEE), a
statutory body under Ministry of Power, Government of India.2004
2. Eastop.T.D& Croft D.R, “Energy Efficiency for Engineers and Technologists”, Logman
Scientific & Technical, ISBN-0-582-03184, 1990
3. W.R. Murphy and G. McKay “Energy Management” Butterworths, London 1987
4. Pratap Bhattacharyya, “Climate Change and Greenhouse Gas Emission”, New India
Publishing Agency- Nipa,2020
5. Matthew John Franchetti , Defne Apul “Carbon Footprint Analysis: Concepts, Methods,
Implementation, and Case Studies” CRC Press,2012
6. Robert A. Ristinen, Jack J. Kraushaar, Jeffrey T. Brack, “Energy and the Environment”, 4th
Edition,Wiley,2022
7. M.H. Fulekar,Bhawana Pathak, R K Kale,“Environment and Sustainable Development”
Springer,2016
8. Sustainable development in India: Stocktaking in the run up to Rio+20: Report prepared by
TERI for MoEF, 2011.
379